US20200399309A1 - Therapeutic agents for reducing parathyroid hormone levels - Google Patents

Therapeutic agents for reducing parathyroid hormone levels Download PDF

Info

Publication number
US20200399309A1
US20200399309A1 US17/010,773 US202017010773A US2020399309A1 US 20200399309 A1 US20200399309 A1 US 20200399309A1 US 202017010773 A US202017010773 A US 202017010773A US 2020399309 A1 US2020399309 A1 US 2020399309A1
Authority
US
United States
Prior art keywords
seq
pth
compound
amino acid
compounds
Prior art date
Legal status (The legal status is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the status listed.)
Abandoned
Application number
US17/010,773
Inventor
Felix Karim
Amos Baruch
Derek MacLean
Kanad Das
Qun Yin
Current Assignee (The listed assignees may be inaccurate. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation or warranty as to the accuracy of the list.)
Kai Pharmaceuticals Inc
Original Assignee
Kai Pharmaceuticals Inc
Priority date (The priority date is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the date listed.)
Filing date
Publication date
Family has litigation
First worldwide family litigation filed litigation Critical https://patents.darts-ip.com/?family=43527590&utm_source=google_patent&utm_medium=platform_link&utm_campaign=public_patent_search&patent=US20200399309(A1) "Global patent litigation dataset” by Darts-ip is licensed under a Creative Commons Attribution 4.0 International License.
Application filed by Kai Pharmaceuticals Inc filed Critical Kai Pharmaceuticals Inc
Priority to US17/010,773 priority Critical patent/US20200399309A1/en
Publication of US20200399309A1 publication Critical patent/US20200399309A1/en
Assigned to KAI PHARMACEUTICALS, INC. reassignment KAI PHARMACEUTICALS, INC. ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST (SEE DOCUMENT FOR DETAILS). Assignors: BARUCH, AMOS, KARIM, FELIX, MACLEAN, DEREK, DAS, KANAD, YIN, QUN
Priority to US17/960,060 priority patent/US20240116983A1/en
Abandoned legal-status Critical Current

Links

Images

Classifications

    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07KPEPTIDES
    • C07K7/00Peptides having 5 to 20 amino acids in a fully defined sequence; Derivatives thereof
    • C07K7/04Linear peptides containing only normal peptide links
    • C07K7/06Linear peptides containing only normal peptide links having 5 to 11 amino acids
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/59Compounds containing 9, 10- seco- cyclopenta[a]hydrophenanthrene ring systems
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K47/00Medicinal preparations characterised by the non-active ingredients used, e.g. carriers or inert additives; Targeting or modifying agents chemically bound to the active ingredient
    • A61K47/50Medicinal preparations characterised by the non-active ingredients used, e.g. carriers or inert additives; Targeting or modifying agents chemically bound to the active ingredient the non-active ingredient being chemically bound to the active ingredient, e.g. polymer-drug conjugates
    • A61K47/51Medicinal preparations characterised by the non-active ingredients used, e.g. carriers or inert additives; Targeting or modifying agents chemically bound to the active ingredient the non-active ingredient being chemically bound to the active ingredient, e.g. polymer-drug conjugates the non-active ingredient being a modifying agent
    • A61K47/56Medicinal preparations characterised by the non-active ingredients used, e.g. carriers or inert additives; Targeting or modifying agents chemically bound to the active ingredient the non-active ingredient being chemically bound to the active ingredient, e.g. polymer-drug conjugates the non-active ingredient being a modifying agent the modifying agent being an organic macromolecular compound, e.g. an oligomeric, polymeric or dendrimeric molecule
    • A61K47/59Medicinal preparations characterised by the non-active ingredients used, e.g. carriers or inert additives; Targeting or modifying agents chemically bound to the active ingredient the non-active ingredient being chemically bound to the active ingredient, e.g. polymer-drug conjugates the non-active ingredient being a modifying agent the modifying agent being an organic macromolecular compound, e.g. an oligomeric, polymeric or dendrimeric molecule obtained otherwise than by reactions only involving carbon-to-carbon unsaturated bonds, e.g. polyureas or polyurethanes
    • A61K47/60Medicinal preparations characterised by the non-active ingredients used, e.g. carriers or inert additives; Targeting or modifying agents chemically bound to the active ingredient the non-active ingredient being chemically bound to the active ingredient, e.g. polymer-drug conjugates the non-active ingredient being a modifying agent the modifying agent being an organic macromolecular compound, e.g. an oligomeric, polymeric or dendrimeric molecule obtained otherwise than by reactions only involving carbon-to-carbon unsaturated bonds, e.g. polyureas or polyurethanes the organic macromolecular compound being a polyoxyalkylene oligomer, polymer or dendrimer, e.g. PEG, PPG, PEO or polyglycerol
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K9/00Medicinal preparations characterised by special physical form
    • A61K9/0012Galenical forms characterised by the site of application
    • A61K9/0019Injectable compositions; Intramuscular, intravenous, arterial, subcutaneous administration; Compositions to be administered through the skin in an invasive manner
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K9/00Medicinal preparations characterised by special physical form
    • A61K9/08Solutions
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P13/00Drugs for disorders of the urinary system
    • A61P13/12Drugs for disorders of the urinary system of the kidneys
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P3/00Drugs for disorders of the metabolism
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P3/00Drugs for disorders of the metabolism
    • A61P3/12Drugs for disorders of the metabolism for electrolyte homeostasis
    • A61P3/14Drugs for disorders of the metabolism for electrolyte homeostasis for calcium homeostasis
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P43/00Drugs for specific purposes, not provided for in groups A61P1/00-A61P41/00
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P5/00Drugs for disorders of the endocrine system
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P5/00Drugs for disorders of the endocrine system
    • A61P5/14Drugs for disorders of the endocrine system of the thyroid hormones, e.g. T3, T4
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P5/00Drugs for disorders of the endocrine system
    • A61P5/18Drugs for disorders of the endocrine system of the parathyroid hormones
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P5/00Drugs for disorders of the endocrine system
    • A61P5/18Drugs for disorders of the endocrine system of the parathyroid hormones
    • A61P5/20Drugs for disorders of the endocrine system of the parathyroid hormones for decreasing, blocking or antagonising the activity of PTH
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07KPEPTIDES
    • C07K5/00Peptides containing up to four amino acids in a fully defined sequence; Derivatives thereof
    • C07K5/04Peptides containing up to four amino acids in a fully defined sequence; Derivatives thereof containing only normal peptide links
    • C07K5/10Tetrapeptides
    • C07K5/1002Tetrapeptides with the first amino acid being neutral
    • C07K5/1005Tetrapeptides with the first amino acid being neutral and aliphatic
    • C07K5/1013Tetrapeptides with the first amino acid being neutral and aliphatic the side chain containing O or S as heteroatoms, e.g. Cys, Ser
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07KPEPTIDES
    • C07K7/00Peptides having 5 to 20 amino acids in a fully defined sequence; Derivatives thereof
    • C07K7/04Linear peptides containing only normal peptide links
    • C07K7/08Linear peptides containing only normal peptide links having 12 to 20 amino acids
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K2300/00Mixtures or combinations of active ingredients, wherein at least one active ingredient is fully defined in groups A61K31/00 - A61K41/00
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K38/00Medicinal preparations containing peptides

Definitions

  • the current subject matter relates to compounds with activity to decrease parathyroid hormone (PTH) levels, to pharmaceutical compositions comprising the compounds, and to the use of such compounds and compositions in methods of treatment, including but not limited to treating hypercalcemia or hyperparathyroidism or modulating in vivo PTH levels.
  • PTH parathyroid hormone
  • Calcium homeostasis is the mechanism by which the body maintains adequate calcium levels. The process is highly regulated, and involves a complex interplay between calcium absorption, transport, storage in bones, deposition in other tissues, and excretion.
  • PTH is a regulator of circulating calcium levels, and functions to increase the concentration of calcium in the blood by enhancing the release of calcium from bone through the process of bone resorption; increasing reabsorption of calcium from the renal tubules; and enhancing calcium absorption in the intestine by increasing the production of 1,25-(OH) 2 vitamin D, the active form of vitamin D.
  • PTH also stimulates phosphorus excretion from the kidney, and increases release from bone.
  • CaSR calcium sensing receptor
  • Ca 2+ extracellular calcium ion
  • PTH protein kinase C
  • the CaSR is also expressed on osteoblasts and in the kidney, where it regulates renal Ca 2+ excretion.
  • PTH regulates phosphorus homeostasis.
  • PTH stimulates the parathyroid hormone receptor 1 (PTHR1) on both apical (brush border membrane) and basolateral membranes of cells in the GI tract.
  • PTHR1 stimulation leads to an increase in urinary excretion of phosphate (Pi) as a consequence of reduction by internalization of the renal Na + /phosphate (NaPi-IIa) co-transporter on the brush border membrane.
  • PTH is also involved in the regulation of osteoblasts and osteoclasts in bone.
  • PTH increases circulating Ca 2+ by increasing bone resorption and renal reabsorption of calcium.
  • PTH stimulates osteoblasts to produce RANK ligand (RANKL), which binds to the RANK receptor and activates the osteoclasts, leading to an increase in bone resorption and an increase in serum Ca 2+ .
  • RPG RANK ligand
  • OPG is a decoy receptor for RANKL which blocks bone resorption. Osteoporosis is caused by an imbalance between the processes of bone resorption by osteoclasts and bone formation by osteoblasts.
  • the human body contains approximately 1 kg of calcium, 99% of which resides in bone. Under normal conditions, circulating calcium ion (Ca 2+ ) is tightly maintained at a level of about 9 to 10 mg/dL (i.e., 2.25-2.5 mmol/L; ⁇ 600 mg). Approximately 1 g of elemental calcium (Ca 2+ ) is ingested daily. Of this amount, approximately 200 mg/day is absorbed, and 800 mg/day is excreted. In addition, approximately 500 mg/day is released by bone resorption or is deposited into bone. About 10 g of Ca 2+ is filtered through the kidney per day, with about 200 mg appearing in the urine, and the remainder being reabsorbed.
  • Hypercalcemia is an elevated calcium level in the blood. Acute hypercalcemia can result in gastrointestinal (anorexia, nausea, vomiting); renal (polyuria, polydipsia), neuro-muscular (depression, confusion, stupor, coma) and cardiac (bradycardia, first degree atrio-ventricular) symptoms. Chronic hypercalcemia is also associated with gastrointestinal (dyspepsia, constipation, pancreatitis); renal (nephrolithiasis, nephrocalcinosis), neuro-muscular (weakness) and cardiac (hypertension block, digitalis sensitivity) symptoms. Abnormal heart rhythms can result, and EKG findings of a short QT interval and a widened T wave suggest hypercalcemia.
  • Hypercalcemia may be asymptomatic, with symptoms more commonly occurring at high calcium levels (12.0 mg/dL or 3 mmol/l). Severe hypercalcemia (above 15-16 mg/dL or 3.75-4 mmol/l) is considered a medical emergency: at these levels, coma and cardiac arrest can result.
  • Hypercalcemia is frequently caused by hyperparathyroidism, leading to excess bone resorption and elevated levels of serum calcium.
  • PTH is overproduced by a single parathyroid adenoma; less commonly, multiple adenomas or diffuse parathyroid gland hyperplasia may be causative.
  • Increased PTH secretion leads to a net increase in bone resorption, with release of Ca 2+ and phosphate (Pi).
  • PTH also enhances renal reabsorption of Ca 2+ and inhibits reabsorption of phosphate (Pi), resulting in a net increase in serum calcium and a decrease in phosphate.
  • Secondary hyperparathyroidism occurs when a decrease in circulating levels of Ca 2+ level stimulates PTH secretion.
  • One cause of secondary hyperparathyroidism is chronic renal insufficiency (also referred to as chronic kidney disease or CKD), such as that in renal polycystic disease or chronic pyelonephritis, or chronic renal failure, such as that in hemodialysis patients (also referred to as end stage renal disease or ESRD).
  • CKD chronic kidney disease
  • CKD chronic kidney disease
  • CKD chronic kidney disease
  • CKD chronic kidney disease
  • CKD chronic kidney disease
  • CKD chronic kidney disease
  • CKD chronic kidney disease
  • CKD chronic kidney disease
  • CKD chronic kidney disease
  • CKD chronic kidney disease
  • ESRD end stage renal disease
  • Excess PTH may be produced in response to hypocalcemia resulting from low calcium intake, GI disorders, renal insufficiency, vitamin D deficiency, and renal hypercalciuria.
  • Malignancy is a common cause of non-PTH mediated hypercalcemia. Hypercalcemia of malignancy, is an uncommon but severe complication of cancer, affecting between 10% and 20% of cancer patients, and may occur with both solid tumors and leukemia. The condition has an abrupt onset and has a very poor prognosis, with a median survival of only six weeks.
  • Growth factors regulate the production of parathyroid hormone-related protein (PTHrP) in tumor cells. Tumor cells may be stimulated by autocrine GF to increase production of PTHrP, leading to enhanced bone resorption. Tumor cells metastatic to bone may also secrete PTHrP, which can resorb bone and release additional GF which in turn act in a paracrine manner to further enhance PTHrP production.
  • GF parathyroid hormone-related protein
  • X 1 is a subunit comprising a thiol-containing group
  • X 5 is a cationic subunit
  • X 6 is a non-cationic subunit
  • X 7 is a cationic subunit
  • at least one, preferably two, of X 2 , X 3 and X 4 is/are independently a cationic subunit
  • the compound has activity to decrease parathyroid hormone concentration.
  • the decrease in parathyroid hormone concentration is a decrease in blood or plasma parathyroid hormone concentration in a subject treated with the compound relative to the blood or plasma parathyroid hormone concentration in the subject prior to treatment.
  • the decrease in parathyroid hormone concentration is achieved in the absence of a histamine response.
  • X 3 and X 4 are non-cationic while X 1 , X 5 , X 6 and X 7 are cationic.
  • the X 1 subunit is a thiol-containing amino acid residue.
  • the thiol group of the X 1 subunit is an organic thiol-containing moiety.
  • the X 1 subunit when the X 1 subunit is a thiol-containing amino acid residue, it is selected from the group consisting of L-cysteine, D-cysteine, glutathione, n-acetylated cysteine, homocysteine and pegylated cysteine.
  • the organic thiol-containing moiety is selected from thiol-alkyl, or thioacyl moieties such as 3-mercaptopropyl or 3-mercaptopropionyl, mercaptopropionic acid, mercaptoacetic acid, thiobenzyl, or thiopropyl.
  • the organic-thiol-containing moiety is mercaptopropionic acid.
  • the X 1 subunit is modified chemically to comprise an acetyl group, a benzoyl group, a butyl group, or another amino acid such as acetylated-beta-alanine.
  • the X 1 subunit when the X 1 subunit comprises a thiol moiety, the X 1 subunit is joined by a covalent linkage to a second thiol moiety.
  • the formula X 1 -X 2 -X 3 -X 4 -X 5 -X 6 -X 7 is comprised of a contiguous sequence of amino acid residues (designated herein as (X aa1 )-(X aa2 )-(X aa3 )-(X aa4 )-(X aa5 )-(X aa6 )-(X aa7 ) SEQ ID NO:1) or a sequence of organic compound subunits (non-amino acid residues).
  • the contiguous sequence of amino acid residues is a contiguous sequence of L-amino acid residues, a contiguous sequence of D-amino acid residues, a contiguous sequence of a mixture of L-amino acid residues and D-amino acid residues, or a mixture of amino acid residues and non-natural amino acid residues.
  • the contiguous sequence of amino acid residues is linked to a compound to facilitate transport across a cell membrane. In another embodiment, the contiguous sequence of amino acid residues is linked to a compound that enhances delivery of the sequence into or across one or more layers of tissue.
  • the contiguous sequence of amino acid residues is contained within a sequence of amino acid residues from 8-50 amino acid residues, 8-40 amino acid residues, 8-30 amino acid residues or 8-20 amino acid residues in length.
  • the contiguous sequence of amino acid residues is contained within a sequence of amino acid residues from 8-19 amino acid residues, 8-18 amino acid residues, 8-17 amino acid residues, 8-16 amino acid residues, 8-15 amino acid residues, 8-14 amino acid residues, 8-13 amino acid residues, 8-12 amino acid residues, 8-11 amino acid residues, 8-10 amino acid residues, or 8-9 amino acid residues in length.
  • the X 3 subunit is a cationic amino acid residue.
  • the X 2 subunit is a non-cationic amino acid residue
  • the X 4 subunit is a non-cationic amino acid residue.
  • the non-cationic amino acid residue is a D-amino acid.
  • X 3 and X 4 are cationic D-amino acid residues.
  • the X 5 subunit is a D-amino acid residue.
  • the contiguous sequence in any of the described compounds is covalently attached via the thiol-containing group in the X 1 subunit to a second contiguous sequence.
  • the second contiguous sequence can be identical to the contiguous sequence (to form a dimer), or can be non-identical, as would be the case when attached to a moiety that facilitates transfer of the contiguous sequence across a cell membrane.
  • a conjugate comprised of the peptide carrrar (SEQ ID NO:2) is provided, where the peptide is conjugated at its N-terminal residue to a Cys residue.
  • the peptide is chemically modified at the N-terminus, the C-terminus, or both.
  • the N-terminus of the peptide is chemically modified by acetylation and the C-terminus is chemically modified by amidation.
  • the conjugate is Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:3).
  • a method of treating secondary hyperparathyroidism (SHPT) in a subject is contemplated, wherein a compound as described herein is provided to the subject.
  • the subject can be suffering from chronic kidney disease or other condition.
  • a method of decreasing parathyroid hormone in a subject is contemplated, wherein a compound as described herein is provided to the subject.
  • a treatment regimen comprising providing a compound according to any of those described herein, in combination with a second agent.
  • the second therapeutic agent is vitamin D, a vitamin D analog or cinacalcet hydrochloride.
  • any one or more of the sequences is contemplated to be individually excepted or removed from the scope of the claims.
  • the peptides identified by any one or more of SEQ ID NOs: 162-182, individually or in any combination, are excluded from the claimed compounds, compositions and methods.
  • FIG. 1 is a graph of parathyroid hormone level, as percent of the baseline pre-dose value, as a function of time, in hours, in rats with acute renal insufficiency (1K1C model), where the rats were dosed with Ac-crrrr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:4, diamonds), Ac-crrrrr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:5, closed squares), Ac-crrrrrr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:6, triangles), Ac-crrrrrrrr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:7, open squares), or saline control (x symbols);
  • FIG. 2A is a graph of IP 1 concentration, in nM, as a function of compound concentration of Ac-carrrar-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:26, squares) and Ac-arrrar-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:29, triangles), as a measure of the compound's ability to activate the human CaSR in an in vitro cell assay when the human CaSR is expressed as a stable transfected HEK-293 cell line;
  • FIG. 2B shows the reduction in PTH concentration upon in vivo administration of peptides identified as SEQ ID NO:26 (Ac-carrrar-NH 2 ) (squares) and as SEQ ID NO:29 (Ac-arrrar-NH 2 ) (diamonds), where the peptides were administered as an IV bolus to normal Sprague Dawley rats at doses of 9 mg/kg for SEQ ID NO:29 and at 0.5 mg/kg for SEQ ID NO:26. An intravenous (IV) bolus of saline was used as a control (dashed line). Plasma PTH levels were assessed prior to dosing and 1, 2, 3 and 4 hours after dosing. Results are presented as group average ⁇ standard deviation (SD), and PTH is shown as percent of the baseline pre-dose value;
  • SD standard deviation
  • FIG. 3 is a bar graph that compares the release of histamine following IV bolus administration of various compounds in normal Sprague Dawley rats, where the compounds Ac-crrrr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:4), Ac-crrrrr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:5), Ac-crrrrr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:6) and Ac-crrrrrrr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:41) were dosed in an equimolar IV bolus dose of 2.1 ⁇ mol/kg, and plasma histamine was measured before dosing (pre-dose), 5, 15 and 30 minutes after dosing;
  • FIG. 4 is a bar graph that compares the release of histamine following IV bolus administration of two compounds in normal Sprague Dawley rats, where the compounds Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:3, cross hatched bars) and Ac-crrrrrr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:6, open bars) were dosed at 3 mg/kg, and plasma histamine was measured before dosing (time zero) and 5, 15 and 30 minutes after dosing;
  • FIG. 5 is a graph of parathyroid hormone level, as percent of the baseline pre-dose value, as a function of time, in hours, in normal rats dosed with 0.5 mg/kg by IV bolus of Ac-crrrrrr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:6, diamonds), Ac-carrrr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:8, squares), Ac-crarrrr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:9, triangles), Ac-crrarrr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:10, x symbols), Ac-crrrarr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:11, * symbols), Ac-crrrrar-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:12, circles) or Ac-crrrrrra-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:13, + symbols);
  • FIGS. 6A-6B are graphs of parathyroid hormone level, as percent of the baseline pre-dose value, as a function of time, in hours, in healthy rats dosed with 0.5 mg/kg by IV bolus of Ac-carrrar-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:26, open diamonds), Ac-crrarar-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:25, open squares), Ac-caarrrr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:22, triangles), Ac-crraarr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:17, closed squares), Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:3, diamonds FIG. 6B ), Ac-craarrr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:24, x symbols in FIG. 6A ); Ac-c(C)rrarar-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:28, x symbols, FIG. 6B );
  • FIG. 7 shows the decrease in parathyroid hormone levels in the blood as a function of time, for the compound Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:3) administered as an IV bolus to normal Sprague Dawley rats at doses of 1 mg/kg (diamonds), 0.5 mg/kg (squares), 0.3 mg/kg (triangles), and 0.1 mg/kg (x symbols).
  • An intravenous (IV) bolus of saline (circles) was used as a control. Plasma PTH levels were assessed prior to dosing and at 1, 2, 3 and 4 hours after dosing.
  • FIG. 8 is a graph of parathyroid hormone level, as percent of the baseline pre-dose value, as a function of time, in hours, in rats with acute renal insufficiency (1K1C model), in rats with 1K1C model of acute renal insufficiency, where the rats were dosed via IV bolus with the compound Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:3) at doses of 3 mg/kg (diamonds), 1 mg/kg (triangles), 0.5 mg/kg (squares) and 0.3 mg/kg (x symbols), or saline (squares); the dashed line in FIG. 8 indicating baseline PTH level pre-dosing;
  • FIG. 9 is a graph of parathyroid hormone level, as percent of the baseline pre-dose value, as a function of time, in hours, in rats dosed intravenously with saline (x symbols) or with the compounds Ac-crrrrrr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:6, open diamonds), and Ac-carrrar-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:26, open squares) at 1 mg/kg via a 30-minute IV infusion, where plasma PTH levels were assessed prior to dosing, 16 hours and 24 hours after dosing;
  • FIG. 10 is a graph of parathyroid hormone level, as percent of the baseline pre-dose value, as a function of time, in hours, in rats with acute renal insufficiency (1K1C model), where the rats were dosed via IV bolus with the compounds Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:3, squares, * symbols) and Ac-c(Ac-C)arrrar-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:146, triangles, diamonds) at doses of 0.3 mg/kg (squares, triangles) and 0.5 mg/kg (*, diamonds);
  • FIG. 11 is a graph of parathyroid hormone level, as percent of the baseline pre-dose value, as a function of time, in hours, in rats treated via micropore-facilitated transdermal delivery of Ac-crrrrr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:6, two animals, squares and triangles) or with saline via transdermal delivery (diamonds);
  • FIG. 12 is a graph of parathyroid hormone level, as percent of the baseline pre-dose value, as a function of time, in hours, in rats treated via micropore-facilitated transdermal delivery of Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:3);
  • FIG. 13 is a graph of mean PTH (as percent of baseline) during and following a 6 hour IV infusion of Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:3) in normal Sprague-Dawley rats, where the compound was infused at rates of 1 ⁇ g/kg/hr (squares), 3 ⁇ g/kg/hr (circles), and 10 ⁇ g/kg/hr (triangles);
  • FIG. 14A shows PTH (as a percent of baseline) during and following a 6 hour IV infusion of Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:3) in the 1K1C rat model of acute renal insufficiency, where rats were intravenously infused at dose rates of 30 ⁇ g/kg/hr (diamonds) and 100 ⁇ g/kg/hr (squares);
  • FIG. 14B is a bar graph showing serum calcium, in mg/dL, for the 1K1C model rats treated as in FIG. 14A .
  • a modulator peptide includes one of more modulator peptides.
  • a compound has “activity to decrease parathyroid hormone level” or “PTH-lowering activity” when the compound, upon administration to a subject, lowers plasma parathyroid hormone (PTH) relative to the plasma PTH concentration prior to administration of the compound.
  • the decrease in PTH level is at least 20%, 30%, 40%, 50%, 60%, 70%, 80%, 90% or 95% lower one hour after compound administration that the PTH level prior to administration of the compound.
  • absence of a histamine response or “lack of a histamine response” intends a dose of a compound that produces a less than 15-fold, 14-fold, 13-fold, 12-fold, 11-fold, 10-fold, 9-fold, 8-fold, 7-fold, 6-fold, 5-fold, 4-fold, or 3-fold increase in histamine, measured in vitro in an assay as described herein, where the fold change is determined based on histamine levels before incubation with the compound and after 15 minutes incubation with compound.
  • amino acid refers to natural and non-natural amino acids.
  • the twenty naturally occurring amino acids are designated by the three letter code with the prefix “L-” (except for glycine which is achiral) or by the one letter code in upper-case: alanine (“L-Ala” or “A”), arginine (“L-Arg” or “R”), asparagine (“L-Asn” or “N”), aspartic acid (“L-Asp” or “D”), cysteine (“L-Cys” or “C”), glutamine (“L-Gln” or “Q”), glutamic acid (“L-Glu” or “E”), glycine (“Gly” or “G”), histidine (“L-His” or “H”), isoleucine (“L-Ile” or “I”), leucine (“L-Leu” or “L”), lysine (“L-Lys” or “K”), methionine
  • L-norleucine and L-norvaline may be represented as (NLeu) and (NVal), respectively.
  • the nineteen naturally occurring amino acids that are chiral have a corresponding D-isomer which is designated by the three letter code with the prefix “D-” or by the lower-case one letter code: alanine (“D-Ala” or “a”), arginine (“D-Arg” or “r”), asparagine (“D-Asn” or “a”), aspartic acid (“D-Asp” or “d”), cysteine (“D-Cys” or “c”), glutamine (“D-Gln” or “q”), glutamic acid (“D-Glu” or “e”), histidine (“D-His” or “h”), isoleucine (“D-Ile” or “i”), leucine (“D-Leu” or “I”), lysine (“D-Lys” or “k”), methionine (“D-Met” or
  • D-norleucine and D-norvaline may be represented as (dNLeu) and (dNVal), respectively.
  • amino acid residue is often used in reference to a monomeric subunit of a peptide, polypeptide or protein
  • amino acid is often used in reference to a free molecule, usage of these terms in the art overlaps and varies.
  • amino acid and amino acid residue are used interchangeably and may refer to a free molecule or a monomeric subunit of a peptide, polypeptide or protein, depending on context.
  • the sequences are aligned for optimal comparison purposes (e.g., gaps can be introduced in the sequence of one polypeptide for optimal alignment with the other polypeptide).
  • the amino acid residues at corresponding amino acid positions are then compared. When a position in one sequence is occupied by the same amino acid residue as the corresponding position in the other sequence, then the molecules are identical at that position.
  • Percent sequence identity between two polypeptide sequences can be determined using the Vector NTI software package (Invitrogen Corporation, 5791 Van Allen Way, Carlsbad, Calif. 92008). A gap opening penalty of 10 and a gap extension penalty of 0.1 are used for determining the percent identity of two polypeptides. All other parameters are set at the default settings.
  • a “cationic amino acid” intends an amino acid residue that has a net positive charge at physiologic pH (7.4), as is the case, for example, in the amino acid residues where the side chain, or “R group”, contains an amine functional group or other functional group that can accept a proton to become positively charged at physiologic pH, such as a guanidine or imidazole moiety.
  • Cationic amino acid residues include arginine, lysine, histidine, 2,3-diaminopropionic acid (Dap), 2,4-diaminobutyric acid (Dab), ornithine, and homoarginine.
  • a “cationic subunit” intends a subunit that has a net positive charge at physiologic pH (7.4).
  • “conservative amino acid substitutions” are substitutions which do not result in a significant change in the activity or tertiary structure of a selected polypeptide or protein. Such substitutions typically involve replacing a selected amino acid residue with a different amino acid residue having similar physico-chemical properties. Groupings of amino acids and amino acid residues by physico-chemical properties are known to those of skill in the art.
  • families of amino acid residues having similar side chains have been defined in the art, and include basic side chains (e.g., lysine, arginine, histidine), acidic side chains (e.g., aspartic acid, glutamic acid), uncharged polar side chains (e.g., glycine, asparagine, glutamine, serine, threonine, tyrosine, cysteine), nonpolar side chains (e.g., alanine, valine, leucine, isoleucine, proline, phenylalanine, methionine, tryptophan), beta-branched side chains (e.g., threonine, valine, isoleucine) and aromatic side chains (e.g., tyrosine, phenylalanine, tryptophan, histidine).
  • basic side chains e.g., lysine, arginine, histidine
  • acidic side chains e.g., aspartic acid
  • chemical cross-linking refers to covalent bonding of two or more molecules.
  • a peptide or peptide fragment is “derived from” a parent peptide or polypeptide if it has an amino acid sequence that is identical or homologous to at least a contiguous sequence of five amino acid residues, more preferably eight amino acid residues, of the parent peptide or polypeptide.
  • the compounds described herein may be in the form of pharmaceutically acceptable salts.
  • Pharmaceutically acceptable salts include acid addition salts, such as hydrochloride, hydrobromide, sulfurate, nitrate, phosphorate, acetate, propionate, glycolate, pyruvate, oxalate, malate, malonate, succinate, maleate, fumarate, tartarate, citrate, benzoate, cinnamate, mandelate, methanesulfonate, ethanesulfonate, p-toluene-sulfonate, salicylate and the like, and base addition salts, such as sodium, potassium, calcium, magnesium, lithium, aluminum, zinc, ammonium, ethylenediamine, arginine, piperazine and the like.
  • acid addition salts such as hydrochloride, hydrobromide, sulfurate, nitrate, phosphorate, acetate, propionate, glycolate, pyruvate, oxalate, malate, malonate, succinate, maleate, fumarate, tartarate
  • hypoparathyroidism refers to primary, secondary and tertiary hyperparathyroidism, unless otherwise indicated.
  • intradermal intends that in the methods of treatment described herein a therapeutically effective amount of a calcimimetic compound is applied to skin to deliver the compound to layers of skin beneath the stratum corneum, and thus achieve a desired therapeutic effect.
  • an “isolated” or “purified” polypeptide or biologically active portion thereof is free of some of the cellular material when produced by recombinant DNA techniques, or chemical precursors or other chemicals when chemically synthesized.
  • the language “substantially free of cellular material” includes preparations of polypeptides in which the polypeptide is separated from some of the cellular components of the cells in which it is naturally or recombinantly produced.
  • the polypeptide or biologically active portion thereof is recombinantly produced, it is also preferably substantially free of culture medium, i.e., culture medium represents less than about 20%, more preferably less than about 10%, and most preferably less than about 5% of the volume of the polypeptide preparation.
  • the language “substantially free of chemical precursors or other chemicals” includes preparations of polypeptides in which the polypeptide is separated from chemical precursors or other chemicals that are involved in the synthesis of the polypeptide.
  • the language “substantially free of chemical precursors or other chemicals” includes preparations of a polypeptide having less than about 30% (by dry weight) of chemical precursors or other chemicals, preferably less than about 20% chemical precursors or other chemicals, more preferably less than about 15% chemical precursors or other chemicals, still more preferably less than about 10% chemical precursors or other chemicals, and most preferably less than about 5% chemical precursors or other chemicals.
  • isolated polypeptides, or biologically active portions thereof lack contaminating polypeptides from the same organism from which the domain polypeptide is derived.
  • macromolecule refers to a molecule, such as a peptide, polypeptide, protein or nucleic acid, that typically has a molecular weight greater than about 900 Daltons.
  • non-cationic amino acid intends an amino acid residue that has no charge or a net negative charge at physiologic pH (7.4), as is the case, for example, in the amino acid residues where the side chain, or “R group”, is neutral (neutral polar and neutral non-polar) and acidic.
  • Non-cationic amino acids include those residues with an R group that is a hydrocarbon alkyl or aromatic moiety (e.g., valine, alanine, leucine, isoleucine, phenylalanine); a neutral, polar R group (asparagine, cysteine, glutamine, serine, threonine, tryptophan, tyrosine); or a neutral, non-polar R group (glycine, methionine, proline, valine, isoleucine).
  • Non-cationic amino acids with an acidic R group include asparatic acid and glutamic acid.
  • a “polymer” refers to a linear chain of two or more identical or non-identical subunits joined by covalent bonds.
  • peptide and “polypeptide” refer to any polymer made up of a chain of amino acid residues linked by peptide bonds, regardless of its size.
  • protein is often used in reference to relatively large polypeptides
  • peptide is often used in reference to small polypeptides, usage of these terms in the art overlaps and varies.
  • the term “peptide” will be used herein, although in some cases the art may refer to the same polymer as a “polypeptide.” Unless otherwise indicated, the sequence for a peptide is given in the order from the amino terminus to the carboxyl terminus.
  • a “thiol-containing group” or “thiol-containing moiety” as used herein intends a functional group comprising a sulfur-hydrogen bond (—SH), and that is capable of reacting with another thiol under physiologic conditions to form a disulfide bond.
  • a thiol that is capable of forming a disulfide bond with another thiol is referred to herein as a “reactive thiol.”
  • the thiol-containing group is less than 6 atoms away from the backbone of the compound.
  • the thiol-containing group has the structure (—SH—CH 2 —CH 2 —C(O)—O—)—.
  • small molecule refers to a molecule other than a macromolecule, such as an organic molecule, and typically has a molecular weight of less than 1000 daltons.
  • subject refers to a human subject or an animal subject.
  • a “subunit” intends a monomeric unit that is joined to more than one other monomeric unit to form a polymeric compound, where a subunit is the shortest repeating pattern of elements in the polymeric compound.
  • Exemplary subunits are amino acids, which when linked form a polymer compound such as those referred to in the art as a peptide, a polypeptide or a protein.
  • a “therapeutically effective amount” is an amount required to produce a desired therapeutic effect.
  • a therapeutically effective amount is the amount required to reduce serum calcium levels by at least 1%, 2%, 3%, 4%, 5%, 6%, 7%, 8%, 9%, 10%, 11%, 12%, 13%, 14%, 15%, 16%, 17%, 18%, 19%, 20% or 25%.
  • Calcium may be measured as total calcium or as ionized calcium.
  • a therapeutically effective amount is the amount required to reduce PTH levels by at least 1%, 2%, 3%, 4%, 5%, 6%, 7%, 8%, 9%, 10%, 11%, 12%, 13%, 14%, 15%, 16%, 17%, 18%, 19%, 20% or 25%.
  • transdermal means that in the methods of treatment described herein a therapeutically effective amount of a calcimimetic agent is applied to skin to deliver the compound to systemic circulation and thus achieve a desired therapeutic effect.
  • a compound comprising the sequence of subunits X 1 -X 2 -X 3 -X 4 -X 5 -X 6 -X 7 is provided, where X 1 is a subunit comprising a thiol group; X 5 is a cationic subunit; X 6 is a non-cationic subunit; X 7 is a cationic a subunit; and at least two of X 2 , X 3 and X 4 are independently a cationic subunit.
  • the compounds have activity to decrease parathyroid hormone (PTH) levels and/or decrease calcium levels in a subject's blood.
  • PTH parathyroid hormone
  • a decrease in parathyroid hormone levels intends a lowering of plasma or blood PTH concentration in a subject relative to the plasma or blood PTH concentration prior to treatment with the compound.
  • the compound achieves a reduction in plasma PTH concentration by at least 50% within one hour after dosing, relative to the plasma PTH prior to dosing.
  • the compounds are exemplified by peptides, although a skilled artisan will appreciate that non-peptidic compounds that have the desired activity can be designed based on the structure-activity relationship studies described herein.
  • parathyroid hormone or PTH is an 84 amino acid peptide produced by the parathyroid gland and its breakdown products. Besides full length PTH (which consists of residues 1-84 and is sometimes referred to as “intact” of “bioactive” PTH) various PTH fragments generated by proteolysis and other routes of metabolism are present in blood.
  • the amino-terminal 1-34 region of the intact PTH molecule is biologically active. This region of the molecule contains the amino acid sequence that enables PTH to bind to the parathyroid hormone receptors in target tissues.
  • the middle and carboxy-terminal 35-84 region of the intact PTH molecule is believed to be biologically inert but possesses immunological reactivity.
  • PTH 7-84 is thought to exert effects that are opposite to those of 1-84 PTH.
  • Various assays have been developed to measure PTH levels including various breakdown products and are reviewed by Souberbielle et. al., Kidney International, 77:93-100 (2010), which is incorporated herein by reference.
  • a compound having activity to decrease PTH level as defined herein is ascertained using a validated PTH quantification method that detects the intact bioactive form of PTH(1-84), and commercially available kits are known in the art (e.g., see Example 3 herein).
  • the 1K1C model is described in Example 1A, and the compounds synthesized for testing included (i) Ac-crrrr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:4), (ii) Ac-crrrrr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:5), (iii) Ac-crrrrr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:6), (iv) Ac-crrrrrr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:7) and (v) saline control.
  • FIG. 1 shows the reduction in plasma PTH levels as a percent of the pre-dosing (baseline) level. All four compounds dosed at 3 mg/kg produced a significant drop in plasma PTH, but differences in the potency and duration of PTH reduction suggest a relationship between the net positive charge and PTH-lowering activity.
  • the compound Ac-crrrrrr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:6; triangles) with six cationic (arginine) subunits had increased efficacy as well as the duration of action compared to the compounds Ac-crrrr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:4; diamonds) and Ac-crrrr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:5; squares), containing four and five cationic (arginine) subunits, respectively.
  • the compound Ac-crrrrrrr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:7) with seven cationic subunits (arginine residues) produced a similar initial drop in PTH as the compounds with fewer cationic residues, but over the 24 hours following dosing was less efficacious than Ac-crrrrrr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:6) and Ac-crrrrr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:5).
  • These latter two compounds produced a mean PTH reduction of ⁇ 40% and 60% at the 24 hour time point, respectively. Both the extent of PTH reduction and duration of PTH are important criteria for obtaining optimal therapeutic benefit for patients in need of treatment.
  • the compound Ac-crrrrrr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:6) was modified by sequential replacement of an arginine residue with an alanine residue at each of the subunit positions X 2 -X 7 .
  • the compounds were characterized in an in vitro human calcium-sensing receptor (CaSR) assay, described in Example 2, wherein HEK 293 cells that express the human calcium-sensing receptor were used to measure activity of exemplary compounds.
  • CaSR human calcium-sensing receptor
  • an AUC (compound treated)/AUC (saline control)*100 that is equal to 0 would be indicative of a highly active PTH-lowering compound that completely suppresses PTH (to an undetectable level) for 4 hours after a single IV administration of isoflurane (IF)-anesthetized normal rats.
  • a value of AUC (compound treated)/AUC (saline control)*100 that is equal to or greater than 100 would be indicative of an inactive compound.
  • substitution at position 5 to produce the compound Ac-crrrarr-NH 2 produced a 5-10 fold reduction in in vitro potency, although the in vivo percent PTH AUC reduction of 45% could be sufficiently active for clinical therapy.
  • substitution of the cationic arginine residue at position 6 with the uncharged (alanine) residue actually improved potency.
  • the data illustrate that cationic and uncharged residues at different positions are not all equal and there are changes in activity as a result of change in the compound structure.
  • the compound is Ac-caarrrr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:22) and in another embodiment, the compound is Ac-craarrr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:24).
  • IP 1 Accumulation of IP 1 following IP 3 production can be obtained by treating the cells used in the assay with Lithium Chloride (LiCl 2 ) which inhibits the enzyme that converts IP 1 to inositol.
  • LiCl 2 Lithium Chloride
  • accumulation of IP 1 was measured in the presence of the exemplary compounds Ac-carrrar-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:26) and Ac-arrrar-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:29). Results are shown in FIG. 2A .
  • the concentration of IP 1 is reported as nM along the Y-axis and compound concentrations of SEQ ID NO:26 or SEQ ID NO:29 are reported as M along the X-axis. Absence of the N-terminal D-cysteine residue from SEQ ID NO:29 dramatically reduced the ability of the compound to activate the CaSR as compared to SEQ ID NO:26. That is, elimination of the N-terminal cysteine residue significantly reduced the potency of the compound, as the peptides Ac-carrrar-NH (SEQ ID NO:26) and Ac-arrrar-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:29) differ only by the presence or absence of the N-terminal D-cysteine.
  • the contribution of the thiol-containing group in the X 1 subunit of the compound was also investigated in an in vivo study.
  • the PTH-lowering activity of the peptides identified as SEQ ID NO:26 (Ac-carrrar-NH 2 ) and as SEQ ID NO:29 (Ac-arrrar-NH 2 ) was evaluated in vivo according to the procedures in Example 4. Plasma PTH levels were assessed prior to dosing and at 1, 2, 3 and 4 hours after dosing. The results are shown in FIG. 2B .
  • a 0.5 mg/kg dose of the peptide Ac-carrrar-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:26) decreased PTH blood concentration to a non-detectable level for up to 4 hours after dosing.
  • the peptide lacking an N-terminal residue with a thiol-containing group, Ac-arrrar-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:29), diamonds did not reduce PTH concentration, even at a substantially higher dose (i.e., 9 mg/kg).
  • the structure-activity relationship of the thiol-containing group in the X 1 subunit of the compound was further analyzed by preparing compounds with differing X 1 subunits.
  • the compounds, shown in Table 3, were tested in vivo in normal rats for activity to reduce PTH.
  • the data in Table 3 illustrates that the thiol-containing X 1 subunit can be varied.
  • Compounds with the following in the N-terminal residue were tested—D-cysteine (cys), D-penicillamine (dPen), d-homocysteine (dHcy) and mercaptopropionic acid (Mpa).
  • a natural or non-natural amino acid such as beta alanine, can be conjugated to the N-terminal thiol-containing residue.
  • cationic compounds such as Ac-crrrrrr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:6) containing different thiol-containing groups in the X 1 subunit effectively reduce PTH in vivo.
  • Substituting the N-terminal cysteine residue with methionine, which does not contain a thiol group resulted in a compound with very poor in vivo PTH-lowering activity (data not shown).
  • compounds of the contiguous sequence of subunits X 1 -X 2 -X 3 -X 4 -X 5 -X 6 -X 7 have activity to decrease parathyroid hormone levels.
  • the thiol-containing group on the X 1 subunit is selected from the group consisting of thiol-containing amino acid residues and organic thiol-containing moieties.
  • the thiol-containing group is capable of reacting with another thiol group under physiologic pH and temperature.
  • the X 1 subunit can be any one of cysteine, glutathione, mercapto-propionic acid, n-acetylated cysteine and PEGylated cysteine.
  • the thiol-containing group is on a non-amino acid residue subunit, such an organic small molecule with a thiol-containing group
  • the X 1 subunit can be a thiol-alkyl, or thioacyl moieties such as 3-mercaptopropyl or 3-mercaptopropionyl residues.
  • the thiol is not homocysteine.
  • the compounds described herein have “clinical activity to decrease parathyroid hormone level”, which intends that the compound, upon administration to a subject, lowers plasma parathyroid hormone as measured by the cumulative PTH area under the curve (PTH AUC) over 4 hours post administration compared to PTH AUC of a corresponding vehicle treated control subject.
  • the plasma PTH concentrations are measured using, for example, a commercially available ELISA kit that detects bioactive intact PTH 1-84 (see Example 3 for a specific kit).
  • compound with clinical activity to decrease parathyroid hormone level reduces the PTH AUC by at least 20%, 30%, 40%, 50%, 60%, 70%, 80%, 90%, 95% compared to the PTH AUC of a corresponding vehicle treated control subject.
  • the X 1 subunit in some embodiments can be modified chemically, such as by chemical modification to include an acetyl group, a benzoyl group, a benzyl group, a butyl group, a natural or unnatural amino acid such as acetylated-beta-alanine or is joined by a covalent linkage to another thiol moiety.
  • Peptide therapeutics may be vulnerable to attack by peptidases. Exopeptidases are typically non-specific enzymes which cleave amino acid residues from the amino or carboxy termini of a peptide or protein.
  • Endopeptidases which cleave within an amino acid sequence, can also be non-specific; however endopeptidases frequently recognize particular amino sequences (recognition sites) and cleave the peptide at or near those sites. Accordingly, modifications to the compound to protect it from proteolytic degradation are contemplated.
  • One method of protecting a peptide from proteolytic degradation involves chemically modifying, or “capping,” the amino and/or carboxy termini of the peptides.
  • chemically modified or “capped” are used interchangeably to refer to the introduction of a blocking group to a terminus or to both termini of the compound via a covalent modification. Suitable blocking groups serve to cap the termini of the peptides without decreasing the biological activity of the peptides. Any residue positioned at the amino or carboxy termini, or both, of the described compounds, including the thiol-containing subunits can be chemically modified.
  • the amino terminus of the compound is chemically modified by acetylation, to provide an N-acetyl peptide (which may be represented as “Ac-” in a structure or formula herein).
  • the carboxy terminus of the described peptides is chemically modified by amidation to provide a primary carboxamide at the C-terminus (which may be represented as “—NH 2 ” in a peptide sequence, structure or formula herein).
  • both the amino terminus and carboxy terminus are chemically modified by acetylation and amidation, respectively.
  • other capping groups are possible.
  • the amino terminus may be capped by acylation with groups such as an acetyl group, a benzoyl group, or with natural or unnatural amino acids such as beta-alanine capped with an acetyl group, or by alkylation with groups such as a benzyl group or a butyl group, or by sulfonylation to form sulfonamides.
  • the carboxy terminus may be esterified, or converted to a secondary amide, and acyl sulfonamide, or the like.
  • the amino terminus or the carboxy terminus may comprise a site for attachment of a polyethylene glycol (PEG) moiety, i.e., the amino or carboxy termini may be chemically modified by reaction with a suitably functionalized PEG.
  • PEG polyethylene glycol
  • Protecting peptides from endopeptidases typically involves identification and elimination of an endopeptidase recognition site from a peptide.
  • Protease recognition sites are well known to those of ordinary skill in the art. Thus it is possible to identify a potential endoprotease recognition site and then eliminating that site by altering the amino acid sequence within the recognition site. Residues in the recognition sequence can be moved or removed to destroy the recognition site. Preferably, a conservative substitution is made with one or more of the amino acids which comprise an identified protease recognition site.
  • a series of compounds having an L-amino acid residue substituted for a D-amino acid residue were prepared based on the PTH-lowering scaffold Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:3).
  • the compounds were administered to subjects and plasma PTH levels were assessed prior to dosing and 1, 2, 3 and 4 hours after dosing, as described in Example 5 and the AUC was calculated as the sum of the PTH concentration values at the time points of 1, 2, 3 and 4 hours, normalized by the AUC for the saline control at the same time points, multiplied by 100.
  • the results are shown in Table 4.
  • the exemplary compounds shown in Table 4 were chemically modified at both the N-terminus and the C-terminus, as indicated by the Ac and NH 2 designations.
  • the X 1 subunit was a D-Cys residue (or L-Cys residue in SEQ ID NO:34) conjugated via a disulfide linkage to an L-Cys residue, as indicated by the parenthetical designation (C).
  • C parenthetical designation
  • the PTH-lowering in vivo data in Table 4 shows that chirality of Arg and Ala affect activity of the compounds.
  • a compound of the sequence X 1 -X 2 -X 3 -X 4 -X 5 -X 6 -X 7 is contemplated, where at least the subunits identified as X 4 and X 7 are D-amino acid residue subunits.
  • the subunits identified as X 4 , X 5 , X 6 and X 7 are D-amino acid residue subunits.
  • the subunits identified as X 3 , X 4 , X 5 , X 6 and X 7 are D-amino acid residue subunits.
  • the subunits identified as X 2 , X 3 , X 4 , X 5 , X 6 and X 7 are D-amino acid residue subunits, and all of the subunits X 1 , X 2 , X 3 , X 4 , X 5 , X 6 and X 7 are D-amino acid residue subunits.
  • the compounds of the structure X 1 -X 2 -X 3 -X 4 -X 5 -X 6 -X 7 are contemplated, wherein X 5 is a cationic subunit.
  • the X 1 is a subunit comprises a thiol group that is capable of reacting with another thiol group under physiologic conditions (a “reactive thiol”, intending a thiol that reacts with another thiol (e.g., cysteine with cysteine) under physiologic conditions of pH 7.4 and body temperature).
  • the CaSR is a 7-transmembrane G-protein-coupled receptor with a large extracellular domain that functions as a homodimeric receptor. There are 18 cysteine residues in the extracellular domain, some of which have been shown by polymorphism or mutational analysis to be important for receptor activity. Of particular note are cysteines 129 and 131 of the Loop 2 region of the extracellular domain. Cysteines 129 and 131 are thought to form an intermolecular disulfide bridge between the two monomers of the receptor complex, which is in a closed or inhibited configuration.
  • cysteine 129 activates the CaSR, as do a number of other mutations including a full deletion of the Loop2 region.
  • the enhanced potency provided by the N-terminal cysteine residue in the described compounds could result from a specific interaction with one or more of the cysteine residues in the extracellular domain of the CaSR.
  • Ac indicates an acetyl capping group
  • NH 2 indicates an amide capping group
  • Ac-bAla is an acetylated beta-alanine
  • GSH indicates reduced glutathione
  • GS indicates oxidized glutathione
  • PEG refers to polyethylene glycol
  • Mpa refers to mercaptopropionic acid.
  • a group bracketed by parentheses indicates that group or moiety is attached to the side-chain of the preceding subunit or amino acid residue.
  • Plasma PTH levels were assessed prior to dosing and 1, 2, 3 and 4 hours after dosing. The results are shown in the tables below, and indicate that: 1) a small amino acid such as alanine, glycine or serine is preferred at position 6 in the Ac-carrrar-NH 2 peptide (SEQ ID NO:26), and 2) the alanine in position 2 in Ac-carrrar-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:26) is much more permissive to substitutions and can be substituted with hydrophobic (e.g. D-Val, D-Leu), aromatic (e.g. D-Phe), or polar (e.g.
  • hydrophobic e.g. D-Val, D-Leu
  • aromatic e.g. D-Phe
  • polar e.g.
  • D-Ser, D-Gln natural amino acids as well as non-natural bulky hydrophobic amino acids (e.g. dNle, dNva) but not acidic ones, and that 3) the alanine residue in position 4 of the Ac-crrarar-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:25) peptide is also very permissive to substitutions and can accommodate most types of natural amino acids (as well as non-natural bulky hydrophobic amino acids (e.g. dNle, dNva) but is not permissive to amino acids that affect secondary conformation, namely glycine or proline or amino acids with acidic side chain.
  • non-natural bulky hydrophobic amino acids e.g. dNle, dNva
  • PTH data were calculated according to the following formula: AUC cmpd treated /AUC saline control *100.
  • GS oxidized glutathione
  • dHcy D-homocysteine
  • Mpa Mercaptopropionic acid
  • PEG polyethylene glycol. **PTH reduction following 0.5 mg/kg IV administration in isoflurane-anesthetized normal rats - PTH was measured at 1, 2, 3 and 4 hours post administration and cumulative AUC was calculated. PTH data were calculated according to the following formula: AUC cmpd treated /AUC saline control *100.
  • the tested peptides included (i) Ac-crrrr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:4), (ii) Ac-crrrrr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:5), (iii) Ac-crrrrr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:6) and (iv) Ac-crrrrrrr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:41).
  • SEQ ID NO:41 8 arginine residues displayed the largest induction of histamine.
  • Other compounds with fewer Arg residues including SEQ ID NO:6 (6 arginine residues), SEQ ID NO:5 (5 arginine residues), and SEQ ID NO:4 (4 arginine residues), also produced a spike in histamine level, but to a lesser extent compared to SEQ ID NO:41.
  • SEQ ID NO:6 SEQ ID NO:5 and SEQ ID NO:4 generated milder responses in their histamine release activity ( ⁇ 2-3 fold above baseline).
  • SEQ ID NO:5 and SEQ ID NO:4 were, however, less potent than SEQ ID NO:6 with respect to lowering plasma PTH.
  • the histamine release triggered by Ac-crrrrrr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:6) peaked at 5 minutes after dosing and returned to baseline levels 15 minutes later ( FIG. 3 ).
  • the histamine release associated with the PTH-lowering compounds Ac-crrrrr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:6) and Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:3) was evaluated in vivo.
  • the compound Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:3) has the following structure:
  • This conjugate structure is denoted herein as Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:273 where the L-Cys residue linked to the thiol-containing residue in the X 1 subunit of the compound (here, a D-Cys residue) via a Cys-Cys disulfide bond, is placed in parenthesis in the formula. This notation is used throughout to designate that the parenthetical moiety is linked to a second thiol-containing group.
  • the compound Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO: 3) has two cationic (arginine) residues substituted with uncharged (alanine) residues at subunit positions X 2 and X 6 .
  • the D-Cys residue in the X 1 position is conjugated to an L-Cys residue.
  • the compound Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:3, cross hatched bars) induced no apparent histamine response, as seen by the data points at 5, 10 and 15 minutes post dosing where the histamine level was not increased relative to the pre-dose (time zero) histamine level.
  • a compound that has activity to decrease PTH level in a subject in the absence of a histamine response is contemplated.
  • absence of a histamine response intends a dose of the compound that produces a less than 10-fold, more preferably 8-fold, still more preferably 5-fold, and even still more preferably 3-fold, increase in histamine, measured in vitro in an assay as described herein, where the fold change is determined based on histamine levels before incubation with the compound and after 15 minutes incubation with compound.
  • the histamine response is determined in an in vitro assay using rat peritoneal mast cells isolated from peritoneal lavage of normal Sprague Dawley rats, and where the fold change is determined based on histamine levels before incubation with the compound and after 15 minutes incubation with compound.
  • the in vitro evaluation of histamine release was performed using isolated rat peritoneal mast cells isolated by peritoneal lavage using cold HBSS+25 mM HEPES pH 7.4 containing heparin (5 u/mL).
  • a compound that has activity to decrease PTH level in a subject in the absence of an clinical histamine response is contemplated.
  • absence of a “clinical histamine response” intends is that a therapeutically effective amount of a compound as described herein is administered to the subject without producing a clinically adverse increase in plasma or blood histamine as measured 5-10 minutes after completion of dosing or over the course of treatment.
  • bolus means administered over one minute or less
  • an increase in plasma or blood histamine 5-10 minutes after completion of dosing that is less than 15-fold, 10-fold, 9-fold, 8-fold, 7-fold, 6-fold, 5-fold, 4-fold, 3-fold, 2-fold above pre-dose levels.
  • the compound comprises a sequence of 3 to 35 amino acid residues, wherein a plurality of positively charged amino acid residue subunits is present in the sequence.
  • the described compounds comprise 5 to 25 subunits, and in a preferred embodiment each subunit is an amino acid residue.
  • the described compounds comprise 6 to 12 subunits.
  • the described compounds comprise 3 to 9 amino acid subunits.
  • the described compounds comprise 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23, 24, 25, 26, 27, 28, 29, 30, 31, 32, 33, 34, or 35 subunits.
  • the subunits of the described compounds are, in one embodiment, independently selected from natural or unnatural amino acids, or their analogs, and may have either the L- or D-configuration (except for glycine which is achiral). Glycine, the aliphatic residues alanine, valine, leucine, or isoleucine, proline, the hydroxyl residues serine and threonine, the acidic residues aspartic acid and glutamic acid, the amide residues asparagine, and glutamine, the basic residues lysine and arginine, histidine, the aromatic residues phenylalanine, tyrosine, and tryptophan, and the sulfur-containing residues methionine and cysteine are all contemplated for use in the described compounds.
  • the number of positively charged subunits, and their density can affect the potency of the compound for reducing PTH.
  • positively charged subunits are separated by one or more other subunits (“separating subunits”).
  • the separating subunits are alanine residues.
  • the chirality of the separating subunit affects the potency of the compound.
  • Positively charged amino acid residues of the described compounds may be a specific natural or unnatural residue, or analog thereof, having either the L- or D-configuration (e.g., L-arginine) that is repeated in the sequence, or may be a variety of natural or unnatural residues, or analogs thereof, having either the L- or D-configuration.
  • the compound is a peptide comprised of from 3 to 20 positively charged amino acid residues, 6 to 12 positively charged amino acid residues, 3 to 9 positively charged amino acid residues.
  • the peptides comprise 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, or 20 positively charged amino acid residues.
  • the positively charged amino acid residues are independently selected from natural amino acids. In some embodiments, the positively charged amino acid residues are independently selected from natural and/or unnatural amino acids. In some embodiments, the positively charged amino acid residues are independently selected from the group consisting of arginine, lysine, histidine, 2,3-diaminopropionic acid (Dap), 2,4-diaminobutyric acid (Dab), ornithine, and homoarginine. In a preferred embodiment, the positively charged amino acid residues are arginine residues.
  • the compound is a peptide and is a single continuous peptide chain or strand. In other embodiments, the compound is a peptide that is branched. In still other embodiments, the peptide is conjugated to one or more thiol-containing moieties (each, a “thiol-containing conjugating group” or a “conjugating group”). In a preferred embodiment, and as merely illustrative, the peptide compound is conjugated to a Cys conjugating group, via a (—S—S—) disulfide bond (for example -Cys-Cys-). As used herein, the term “compound” is intended to encompass both such peptides and such conjugates.
  • the compounds typically comprise one or more thiol moieties, preferably one or more reactive thiol moieties.
  • Subunits that have a thiol group include non-amino acid compounds having a thiol group and amino acids with a thiol group.
  • the thiol group of the thiol-containing subunit may be in a conjugated form (e.g., via a disulfide bond to a conjugating group) or in an unconjugated form (i.e., as a reduced thiol).
  • the thiol group when the thiol group is in either an unconjugated form or a conjugated form, it is capable of forming a disulfide bond with a thiol-containing group.
  • the thiol-containing residue may be located at any position along the peptide chain, including the amino terminus, the carboxy terminus, or some other position. In a preferred embodiment, the thiol-containing residue or subunit may be located at the amino terminus. In other embodiments, the thiol-containing residue or subunit may be located at the carboxy terminus or within the peptide sequence.
  • thiol-containing residues include, without limitation, cysteine, mercaptopropionic acid, homo-cysteine, and penicillamine.
  • cysteine mercaptopropionic acid
  • homo-cysteine homo-cysteine
  • penicillamine penicillamine
  • the cross-linkage between the thiol containing subunit at the X 1 position in the compound and the thiol-containing conjugating group may be cleavable and/or exchangeable with other thiol-containing conjugating groups such as cysteine (e.g., by reduction of the disulfide linkage) in vivo to yield a biologically active form of the compound.
  • cysteine e.g., by reduction of the disulfide linkage
  • a conjugating group also may be used to modify the physicochemical, pharmacokinetic and/or pharmacodynamic properties of the described compounds (e.g., conjugation via a disulfide linkage to a large PEGylated moiety to enhance the pharmacokinetics).
  • the compound is a peptide comprised of the amino acid sequence (X aa1 )-(X aa2 )-(X aa3 )-(X aa4 )-(X aa5 )-(X aa6 )-(X aa7 ) (SEQ ID NO:155), wherein (X aa1 ) is a thiol-containing amino acid residue, (X aa2 ) is a non-cationic amino acid residue, (X aa3 ) is any amino acid residue, (X aa4 ) is any amino acid residue, (X aa5 ) is a cationic amino acid residue, (X aa6 ) is a non-cationic residue, and (X aa7 ) is any amino acid residue.
  • the peptide may be modified at the N-terminus, the C-terminus, or both. In a preferred embodiment, the peptide is modified at both the N-terminus and C-
  • a peptide comprises the amino acid sequence ( D -Cys)-(X aa2 )-(X aa3 )-(X aa4 )-(X aa5 )-(X aa6 )-(X aa7 ) (SEQ ID NO:156), wherein (X aa2 ) is a non-cationic amino acid residue, (X aa3 ) is any amino acid residue, (X aa4 ) is any amino acid residue, (X aa5 ) is selected from the group consisting of D-Arg, L-Arg, D-Lys and L-Lys, (X aa6 ) is a non-cationic residue, and (X aa7 ) is any amino acid residue.
  • the peptide may have an N-terminal cap, a C-terminal cap, or both. In a preferred embodiment, the peptide has both an N-terminal cap and a C-terminal cap.
  • a peptide comprises the amino acid sequence ( D -Cys)-(X aa2 )-(X aa3 )-(X aa4 )-(X aa5 )-(X aa6 )-(X aa7 ) (SEQ ID NO:157), wherein (X aa2 ), (X aa3 ) and (X aa4 ) are, independently, any amino acid residue (but in a preferred embodiment are, independently, selected from the group consisting of D-Ala, D-Val, D-Leu, D-NorVal, and D-NorLeu), (X aa5 ) and (X aa7 ) are, independently, any cationic amino acid residue (but in a preferred embodiment are, independently, selected from the group consisting of D-Arg, L-Arg, D-Lys and L-Lys), (X aa6 ) is a non-cationic amino acid residue (in a preferred
  • a peptide comprises the amino acid sequence (D-Cys)-(X aa2 )-(X aa3 )-(X aa4 )-(X aa5 )-(X aa6 )-(X aa7 ) (SEQ ID NO:158), wherein (X aa2 ) is a non-cationic amino acid residue, (X aa3 ) is any amino acid residue, (X aa4 ) is any amino acid residue, (X aa5 ) is selected from the group consisting of D-Arg, L-Arg, D-Lys and L-Lys, (X aa6 ) is a non-cationic residue, and (X aa7 ) is any amino acid residue.
  • the peptide may have an N-terminal cap, a C-terminal cap, or both. In a preferred embodiment, the peptide has both an N-terminal cap and a C-terminal cap.
  • a peptide comprises the amino acid sequence (D-Cys)-(D-Ala)-(X aa3 )-(X aa4 )-(D-Arg)-(D-Ala)-(X aa7 ) (SEQ ID NO:159), wherein (X aa3 ) is any cationic amino acid residue, (X aa4 ) is any cationic amino acid residue, and (X aa7 ) is any cationic amino acid residue.
  • the peptide may have an N-terminal cap, a C-terminal cap, or both. In a preferred embodiment, the peptide has both an N-terminal cap and a C-terminal cap.
  • a peptide comprises the amino acid sequence (D-Cys)-(X aa2 )-(X aa3 )-(D-Ala)-(D-Arg)-(D-Ala)-(X aa7 ) (SEQ ID NO:160), wherein (X aa2 ), (X aa3 ) and (X aa7 ) are, independently, any cationic amino acid residue.
  • the peptide may have an N-terminal cap, a C-terminal cap, or both. In a preferred embodiment, the peptide has both an N-terminal cap and a C-terminal cap.
  • Another embodiment is a calcimimetic peptide, comprising a sequence of amino acids linked by peptide bonds, wherein the sequence comprises 5 to 10 amino acid residues, and wherein the sequence comprises an amino terminus, a carboxy terminus, at least one thiol-containing residue, and from 3 to 9 positively charged residues.
  • the at least one thiol-containing residue is a cysteine residue.
  • the cysteine residue is positioned at the amino terminus of the peptide.
  • the cysteine residue is an L -Cys residue, a D -Cys residue, or an L- or D-homoCys residue.
  • the amino acid residues of the peptide are D -amino acids or L -amino acids.
  • peptidomimetic molecules that comprise approximately seven subunits, wherein at least one subunit contains a thiol moiety, preferably a reactive thiol moiety, and other subunits are a plurality of non-cationic subunits, and from 1 to 4 positively charged subunits.
  • Such peptidomimetic molecules may comprise non-peptide bonds between two or more of the subunits.
  • the subunits used to construct the molecules can be naturally-occurring amino acids, or residues with non-natural side chains, the termini of the modules can be capped or non-capped in the manner discussed above.
  • amino acid residues of the molecule can be L - or D -amino acid residues.
  • the thiol-containing residues can be in a reduced or oxidized form with any of the thiol-containing moieties discussed above.
  • the compound is chemically cross-linked to a thiol-containing conjugating group via a disulfide bond between the thiol of the compound and a thiol from the conjugating group.
  • the thiol-containing conjugating group can be a small molecule, such as cysteine, or a macromolecule, such as a polypeptide containing a cysteine residue.
  • thiol-containing conjugating groups examples include cysteine, glutathione, thioalkyl, moieties such as thiobenzyl, mercaptopropionic acid, N-acetylated cysteine, cysteamide, N-acetylcysteamide, homocysteine, penicillamine and poly (ethylene glycol) (PEG) modified (referred to as “PEGylated”) thiols such as PEGylated cysteine or a duplication of the compound (i.e., to form a homodimer linked by a disulfide linkage).
  • the thiol-containing conjugating group is cysteine.
  • cysteine homologs are also contemplated for use as thiol-containing conjugating groups, either alone or comprised in a larger conjugating group.
  • stereoisomers of cysteine, homocysteine, and cysteamide are suitable for use as thiol-containing moieties.
  • Conjugating groups can be used to improve chemical stability and therefore shelf-life of a pharmaceutical product.
  • the thiol-containing conjugating group and the peptide are the same (i.e., the conjugate is a dimer), which unexpectedly showed very good chemical stability compared to heterologous conjugating group such as cysteine.
  • any disproportionation e.g., scrambling of the conjugating group
  • disproportionation of a compound with a heterologous conjugating group such as cysteine
  • cysteine can lead to formation of homo-dimers of the peptide plus cystine (cysteine-cysteine homodimer) plus residual parent compound.
  • a homo-dimer of the peptide i.e., conjugating group and the peptide are the same
  • the teachings include a disulfide conjugate of a thiol-containing conjugating group and a peptide comprising the amino acid sequence (X aa1 )-(X aa2 )-(X aa3 )-(X aa4 )-(X aa5 )-(X aa6 )-(X aa7 ) (SEQ ID NO:155), wherein (X aa1 ) is an amino acid residue with a thiol-containing moiety, (X aa2 ) is a non-cationic amino acid residue, (X aa3 ) is any amino acid residue, (X aa4 ) is any amino acid residue, (X aa5 ) is a cationic amino acid residue, (X aa6 ) is a non-cationic residue, and (X aa7 ) is any amino acid residue.
  • the peptide may have an N-terminal cap, a C-terminal cap, or both. In a preferred embodiment, the peptide has both an N-terminal cap and a C-terminal cap.
  • the thiol-containing conjugating group is selected from the group consisting of D-Cys, L-Cys, a peptide containing D-Cys, and a peptide containing L-Cys. When the thiol-containing conjugate group is an amino acid or a peptide, it may have an N-terminal cap, a C-terminal cap, or both. In a preferred embodiment, the thiol-containing conjugate group has both an N-terminal cap and a C-terminal cap.
  • the thiol-containing conjugating group is itself a peptide comprising the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO:155. In some embodiments, the thiol-containing conjugating group and the peptide are the same (i.e., the conjugate is a dimer).
  • the teachings include a conjugate of a thiol-containing conjugating group and a peptide comprising the amino acid sequence (D-Cys)-(X aa2 )-(X aa3 )-(X aa4 )-(X aa5 )-(X aa6 )-(X aa7 ) (SEQ ID NO:156), wherein (X aa2 ) is a non-cationic amino acid residue, (X aa3 ) is any amino acid residue, (X aa4 ) is any amino acid residue, (X aa5 ) is selected from the group consisting of D-Arg, L-Arg, D-Lys and L-Lys, (X aa6 ) is a non-cationic residue, and (X aa7 ) is any amino acid residue.
  • D-Cys amino acid sequence
  • the peptide may have an N-terminal cap, a C-terminal cap, or both. In a preferred embodiment, the peptide has both an N-terminal cap and a C-terminal cap.
  • the thiol-containing conjugating group is selected from the group consisting of D-Cys, L-Cys, a peptide containing D-Cys, and a peptide containing L-Cys. When the thiol-containing conjugate group is an amino acid or a peptide, it may have an N-terminal cap, a C-terminal cap, or both. In a preferred embodiment, the thiol-containing conjugate group has both an N-terminal cap and a C-terminal cap.
  • the thiol-containing conjugating group is itself a peptide comprising the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO:156. In some embodiments, the thiol-containing conjugating group and the peptide are the same (i.e., the conjugate is a dimer).
  • the teachings include a conjugate of a thiol-containing conjugating group and a peptide comprising the amino acid sequence (L-Cys)-(X aa2 )-(X aa3 )-(X aa4 )-(X aa5 )-(X aa6 )-(X aa7 ) (SEQ ID NO:183), wherein (X aa2 ) is a non-cationic amino acid residue, (X aa3 ) is any amino acid residue, (X aa4 ) is any amino acid residue, (X aa5 ) is selected from the group consisting of D-Arg, L-Arg, D-Lys and L-Lys, (X aa6 ) is a non-cationic residue, and (X aa7 ) is any amino acid residue.
  • (X aa2 ) is a non-cationic amino acid residue
  • (X aa3 ) is any amino acid residue
  • the peptide may have an N-terminal cap, a C-terminal cap, or both. In a preferred embodiment, the peptide has both an N-terminal cap and a C-terminal cap.
  • the thiol-containing conjugating group is selected from the group consisting of D-Cys, L-Cys, a peptide containing D-Cys, and a peptide containing L-Cys. When the thiol-containing conjugate group is an amino acid or a peptide, it may have an N-terminal cap, a C-terminal cap, or both. In a preferred embodiment, the thiol-containing conjugate group has both an N-terminal cap and a C-terminal cap.
  • the thiol-containing conjugating group is itself a peptide comprising the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO:183. In some embodiments, the thiol-containing conjugating group and the peptide are the same (i.e., the conjugate is a dimer).
  • the teachings include a conjugate of a thiol-containing conjugating group and a peptide comprising the amino acid sequence (D-Cys)-(D-Ala)-(X aa3 )-(X aa4 )-(D-Arg)-(D-Ala)-(X aa7 ) (SEQ ID NO:161), wherein (X aa3 ) is any amino acid residue, (X aa4 ) is any amino acid residue, and (X aa7 ) is any amino acid residue.
  • the peptide may have an N-terminal cap, a C-terminal cap, or both.
  • the peptide has both an N-terminal cap and a C-terminal cap.
  • the thiol-containing conjugating group is selected from the group consisting of D-Cys, L-Cys, a peptide containing D-Cys, and a peptide containing L-Cys.
  • the thiol-containing conjugate group is an amino acid or a peptide, it may have an N-terminal cap, a C-terminal cap, or both.
  • the thiol-containing conjugate group has both an N-terminal cap and a C-terminal cap.
  • the thiol-containing conjugating group is itself a peptide comprising the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO:161. In some embodiments, the thiol-containing conjugating group and the peptide are the same (i.e., the conjugate is a dimer).
  • methods to prevent, treat or ameliorate hyperparathyroidism, bone disease and/or other hypercalcemic disorders by administering the compounds described herein are contemplated.
  • the compounds have activity to decrease PTH and/or calcium levels in a target tissue or tissues, or in a subject.
  • the described compounds are capable of decreasing PTH and/or calcium levels when a therapeutically effective amount of the compound is administered to a subject in need of such treatment.
  • FIG. 5 shows the time profile of each compound's ability to reduce blood PTH and the duration of action of the varying compounds.
  • the compounds Ac-crrrrrr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:6, diamonds), Ac-carrrrr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:8, squares) and Ac-crrarrr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:10, x symbols) and Ac-crrrrar-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:12, circles) were potent in vivo, as evidenced by the decrease in percent PTH of predose baseline to essentially zero and provided a duration of potency, where the PTH blood concentration remained decreased for at least four hours.
  • the compounds Ac-crarrrr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:9, triangles), Ac-crrrarr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:11, * symbols) and Ac-crrrrra-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:13, + symbols) decreased percent PTH of baseline for about 2-3 hours, and thereafter the blood concentration of PTH began to increase. Substitution of the cationic (arginine) residue at subunit positions 5 or 7 of Ac-crrrrrr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:6) impacted the duration of PTH lowering activity.
  • a dose-related PTH reduction was observed following a single IV bolus administration with the highest dose of 1 mg/kg (diamonds) had the largest reduction in PTH, followed by the 0.5 mg/kg (squares), 0.3 mg/kg (triangles), and 0.1 mg/kg (x symbols).
  • the saline control is shown by the circles symbols.
  • the peptide when administered at a therapeutically effective dose achieves a reduction in PTH of greater than 50% relative to the concentration of PTH before dosing (“baseline”).
  • baseline concentration of PTH before dosing
  • the peptide when administered at doses of greater than 0.1 mg/kg reduced PTH concentration to less than 90% of the baseline PTH concentration 1 hour after IV administration.
  • a control group of animals was dosed with saline. Plasma PTH levels were assessed prior to dosing and for several hours thereafter.
  • Ac-carrrar-NH 2 shows activity that is equivalent to Ac-crrrrrr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:6, open diamonds) at the dose tested (1 mg/kg) with similar extended duration of action over 24 hours.
  • the analog of Ac-crrrrrr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:6) with uncharged subunit substitutions was found to retain activity and may, in fact, have in vivo potency and duration of action superior to that of the compound identified as SEQ ID NO:6.
  • Ac-carrrar-NH 2 SEQ ID NO:26
  • D-Arg residues at positions X 2 and X 6 were substituted with D-Ala residues relative to the compound identified as SEQ ID NO:6.
  • a compound that has activity to decrease PTH where the compound when administered and a subject, human or otherwise, decreases PTH level to below 50% of the pre-dose level within one hour after dosing.
  • a compound that has significant activity to decrease PTH intends a compound that when administered to a normal rate decreases PTH level to below 50% of the pre-dose level within one hour after dosing by IV bolus.
  • the compound that is linked to the thiol-containing moiety in the X 1 subunit is identified parenthetically, where in these exemplary conjugates the compound L-Cys is indicated (C) is linked to the thiol-containing moiety in the X 1 subunit: Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:3) and Ac-c(Ac-C)arrrar-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:141).
  • C is linked to the thiol-containing moiety in the X 1 subunit: Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:3) and Ac-c(Ac-C)arrrar-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:141).
  • This in vivo dose response with SEQ ID NO:3 displays a dose-dependent reduction in PTH very similar to Ac-crrrrrr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:6).
  • the compounds including compounds in conjugate form where the thiol in the X 1 subunit is cross-linked via a disulfide bond to another subunit, were administered as a 30-minute IV infusion.
  • shorter infusions e.g., ⁇ 5 minutes
  • delivery by IV bolus typically produce comparable pharmacodynamic reduction of PTH as a longer 30-minute infusion.
  • Subcutaneous bolus administration also proved to be an efficacious route of delivery that generated a smaller initial drop in PTH but displayed a sustained reduction in PTH similar to the profile seen by the IV route. As shown in FIG.
  • the compound Ac-crrrrrr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:6)
  • the compound Ac-crrrrrr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:6), was also administered by the transdermal route after microporation resulting in a reduction in plasma PTH for several hours.
  • Transdermal delivery of Ac-crrrrrr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:6) provides an addition option for clinical delivery of the described compounds.
  • a subject having secondary hyperparathyroidism is treated using the described compounds to reduce plasma PTH levels and/or calcium.
  • Untreated SHPT patients with moderately severe hyperparathyroidism often have baseline circulating intact PTH levels >300 ⁇ g/ml, and levels that can exceed 600 ⁇ g/mL.
  • the decrease in PTH levels is measured as a decrease in intact PTH below pretreatment baseline levels.
  • the desired decrease in PTH is to bring the plasma PTH levels into generally recognized guidelines established by the National Kidney Foundation or other experts in the treatment of kidney disorders and renal insufficiency.
  • methods for treating hyperparathyroidism, hypercalcemia and/or bone disease comprising administering a therapeutically effective amount of a described compound.
  • the subject can be treated with a described compound in combination with one or more other therapeutically effective agents.
  • the described compound is administered in an amount effective to reduce PTH or PTH effect.
  • the reduction in plasma PTH is at least 1%, 2%, 3%, 4%, 5%, 6%, 7%, 8%, 9%, 10%, 11%, 12%, 13%, 14%, 15%, 16%, 17%, 18%, 19%, 20%, 25% or 30% below pretreatment baseline levels for at least 10 hours post administration of the described compound.
  • the reduction in plasma PTH is at least 20% at 10 hours post administration.
  • the reduction in plasma PTH is 15 to 40%, preferably 20 to 50%, more preferably 30 to 70% below pretreatment baseline levels for at least 48 hours post administration of the described compound.
  • the described compound is administered in an amount effective to decrease serum calcium or calcium effect.
  • the reduction in serum calcium is at least 1%, 2%, 3%, 4%, 5%, 6%, 7%, 8%, 9%, 10%, 11%, 12%, 13%, 14%, 15%, 16%, 17%, 18%, 19%, 20% or 25% below pretreatment levels for at least 10 hours post administration of the polycationic peptide.
  • the reduction in serum calcium is at least 5% at 10 hours post administration.
  • the reduction is serum calcium is 5 to 10%, preferably 5 to 20% below pretreatment levels for at least 48 hours post administration of the described compound.
  • a method for treating hyperparathyroidism and/or hypercalcemia in a subject in need thereof comprising: administering a therapeutically effective amount of a described compound, whereby PTH and/or calcium is reduced.
  • the described compounds are beneficial for the treatment of various forms of bone disease and/or hypercalcemia in addition to hyperparathyroidism.
  • the described compounds may have advantages compared to current therapeutic agents, because they may be administered parenterally and may not be associated with gastrointestinal adverse effects, are not metabolized by cytochrome P450 and may result in more effective reductions in plasma PTH and calcium.
  • Such other therapeutically effective agents include, but are not limited to, treatment with antiresorptive bisphosphonate agents, such as alendronate and risedronate; integrin blockers, such as ⁇ v ⁇ 3 antagonists; conjugated estrogens used in hormone replacement therapy, such as PREMPROTM, PREMARINTM and ENDOMETRIONTM; selective estrogen receptor modulators (SERMs), such as raloxifene, droloxifene, CP-336,156 (Pfizer) and lasofoxifene; cathespin K inhibitors; vitamin D therapy; vitamin D analogs, such as ZEMPLARTM (paricalcitol); CALCIJEX® (calcitriol), HECTOROL® (doxercalciferol), ONE-ALPHA® (alfacalcidol) and the analogs in development from Cytochroma known as CTA-018, CTAP201 and CTAP101
  • a described compound is administered at a dose sufficient to decrease both PTH and serum calcium levels. In another embodiment, a described compound is administered at a dose sufficient to decrease PTH without significantly affecting serum calcium levels. In a further embodiment, a described compound is administered at a dose sufficient to increase PTH without significantly affecting serum calcium levels.
  • a pharmaceutical composition comprising a described compound and at least one pharmaceutically acceptable excipient or carrier.
  • Methods of preparing such pharmaceutical compositions typically comprise the step of bringing into association a described compound with a carrier and, optionally, one or more accessory ingredients.
  • the described compounds and/or pharmaceutical compositions comprising same may be formulated into pharmaceutically-acceptable dosage forms by conventional methods known to those of skill in the art. Typically, formulations are prepared by uniformly and intimately bringing into association a described compound with liquid carriers, or finely divided solid carriers, or both, and then, if necessary, shaping the product.
  • compositions of the present invention suitable for parenteral administration comprise one or more described compounds in combination with one or more pharmaceutically-acceptable sterile isotonic aqueous or nonaqueous solutions, dispersions, suspensions or emulsions, or sterile powders which may be reconstituted into sterile injectable solutions or dispersions just prior to use, which may contain sugars, alcohols, amino acids, antioxidants, buffers, bacteriostats, solutes which render the formulation isotonic with the blood of the intended recipient or suspending or thickening agents.
  • aqueous and nonaqueous carriers examples include water, ethanol, polyols (such as glycerol, propylene glycol, polyethylene glycol, and the like), and suitable mixtures thereof, vegetable oils, such as olive oil, and injectable organic esters, such as ethyl oleate.
  • polyols such as glycerol, propylene glycol, polyethylene glycol, and the like
  • vegetable oils such as olive oil
  • injectable organic esters such as ethyl oleate.
  • Proper fluidity can be maintained, for example, by the use of coating materials, such as lecithin, by the maintenance of the required particle size in the case of dispersions, and by the use of surfactants.
  • compositions may also contain adjuvants such as preservatives, wetting agents, emulsifying agents and dispersing agents. Prevention of the action of microorganisms upon the described compounds may be ensured by the inclusion of various antibacterial and antifungal agents, for example, paraben, chlorobutanol, phenol sorbic acid, and the like. It may also be desirable to include agents to control tonicity, such as sugars, sodium chloride, and the like into the compositions. In addition, prolonged absorption of the injectable pharmaceutical form may be brought about by the inclusion of agents which delay absorption such as aluminum monostearate and gelatin.
  • adjuvants such as preservatives, wetting agents, emulsifying agents and dispersing agents.
  • the absorption of the drug in order to prolong the effect of a drug, it is desirable to slow the absorption of the drug from subcutaneous or intramuscular injection. This may be accomplished by the use of a liquid suspension of crystalline or amorphous material having poor water solubility. The rate of absorption of the drug then depends upon its rate of dissolution which, in turn, may depend upon crystal size and crystalline form. Alternatively, delayed absorption of a parenterally-administered drug form is accomplished by dissolving or suspending the drug in an oil vehicle.
  • a described compound may be delivered to a human in a form of solution that is made by reconstituting a solid form of the drug with liquid.
  • This solution may be further diluted with infusion fluid such as water for injection, 0.9% sodium chloride injection, 5% dextrose injection and lactated ringer's injection. It is preferred that the reconstituted and diluted solutions be used within 4-6 hours for delivery of maximum potency.
  • a described compound may be delivered to a human in a form of tablet or capsule.
  • Injectable depot forms are made by forming microencapsulated matrices of the described compounds in biodegradable polymers such as polylactide-polyglycolide. Depending on the ratio of drug to polymer, and the nature of the particular polymer employed, the rate of drug release can be controlled. Examples of other biodegradable polymers include poly(orthoesters) and poly(anhydrides). Depot injectable formulations are also prepared by entrapping the drug in liposomes or microemulsions which are compatible with body tissue.
  • the described compounds When the described compounds are administered as pharmaceuticals, to humans and animals, they can be given alone or as a pharmaceutical composition containing, for example, 0.1 to 99% (more preferably, 10 to 30%) of active ingredient in combination with a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier. In other embodiments, the pharmaceutical composition may contain 0.2-25%, preferably 0.5-5% or 0.5-2%, of active ingredient.
  • These compounds may be administered to humans and other animals for therapy by any suitable route of administration, including, e.g., subcutaneous injection, subcutaneous depot, intravenous injection, intravenous or subcutaneous infusion. These compounds may be administered rapidly (within ⁇ 1 minute) as a bolus or more slowly over an extended period of time (over several minutes, hours or days). These compounds may be delivered daily or over multiple days, continuously or intermittently. In one embodiment, the compounds may be administered transdermally (e.g., using a patch, microneedles, micropores, ointment, microjet or nanojet).
  • the described compounds which may be used in a suitable hydrated form, and/or the pharmaceutical compositions, are formulated into pharmaceutically-acceptable dosage forms by conventional methods known to those of skill in the art.
  • Actual dosage levels of the active ingredients in the pharmaceutical compositions may be varied so as to obtain an amount of the active ingredient which is effective to achieve the desired therapeutic response for a particular patient, composition, and mode of administration, without being toxic to the patient.
  • the selected dosage level will depend upon a variety of factors including the activity of the particular described compound employed, or the ester, salt or amide thereof, the route of administration, the time of administration, the rate of excretion or metabolism of the particular compound being employed, the rate and extent of absorption, the duration of the treatment, other drugs, compounds and/or materials used in combination with the particular compound employed, the age, sex, weight, condition, general health and prior medical history of the patient being treated, and like factors well known in the medical arts.
  • a physician or veterinarian having ordinary skill in the art can readily determine and prescribe the effective amount of the pharmaceutical composition required.
  • the physician or veterinarian could start doses of the described compounds employed in the pharmaceutical composition at levels lower than that required in order to achieve the desired therapeutic effect and gradually increase the dosage until the desired effect is achieved.
  • a suitable daily dose of a described compound will be that amount of the compound which is the lowest dose effective to produce a therapeutic effect. Such an effective dose will generally depend upon the factors described above. Generally, intravenous, intramuscular, transdermal, intracerebroventricular and subcutaneous doses of the described compounds for a patient, when used for the indicated effects, will range from about 1 ⁇ g to about 5 mg per kilogram of body weight per hour. In other embodiments, the dose will range from about 5 ⁇ g to about 2.5 mg per kilogram of body weight per hour. In further embodiments, the dose will range from about 5 ⁇ g to about 1 mg per kilogram of body weight per hour.
  • the effective daily dose of a described compound may be administered as two, three, four, five, six or more sub-doses administered separately at appropriate intervals throughout the day, optionally, in unit dosage forms.
  • the described compound is administered as one dose per day.
  • the compound is administered continuously, as through intravenous or other routes.
  • the compound is administered less frequently than daily, such as every 2-3 days, in conjunction with dialysis treatment, weekly or less frequently.
  • the subject receiving this treatment is any animal in need, including primates, in particular humans, and other mammals such as equines, cattle, swine and sheep; and poultry and pets in general.
  • the described compounds may be administered as such or in admixtures with pharmaceutically acceptable carriers and can also be administered in conjunction with antimicrobial agents such as penicillins, cephalosporins, aminoglycosides and glycopeptides.
  • Conjunctive therapy thus includes sequential, simultaneous and separate administration of the active compound in a way that the therapeutical effects of the first administered one is not entirely disappeared when the subsequent is administered.
  • route of administration is intended to include, but is not limited to subcutaneous injection, subcutaneous depot, intravenous injection, intravenous or subcutaneous infusion, intraocular injection, intradermal injection, intramuscular injection, intraperitoneal injection, intratracheal administration, intraadiposal administration, intraarticular administration, intrathecal administration, epidural administration, inhalation, intranasal administration, sublingual administration, buccal administration, rectal administration, vaginal administration, intracisternal administration and topical administration, transdermal administration, or administration via local delivery (for example by catheter or stent).
  • Transdermal drug delivery to the body is a desirable and convenient method for systemic delivery of biologically active substances to a subject, and in particular for delivery of substances that have poor oral bioavailability, such as proteins and peptides.
  • the transdermal route of delivery has been particularly successful with small (e.g., less than about 1,000 Daltons) lipophilic compounds, such as scopolamine and nicotine, that can penetrate the stratum corneum outer layer of the skin, which serves as an effective barrier to entry of substances into the body.
  • small lipophilic compounds such as scopolamine and nicotine
  • the viable epidermis which contains no blood vessels, but has some nerves. Deeper still is the dermis, which contains blood vessels, lymphatics and nerves. Drugs that cross the stratum corneum barrier can generally diffuse to the capillaries in the dermis for absorption and systemic distribution.
  • calcimimetic agents As noted above, PTH secretion is regulated by the CaSR which is expressed on the cell surface of parathyroid cells. Thus, in order to activate the CaSR, the agent or compound must be delivered to the parathyroid cell. Transdermal delivery of calcimimetic agents must achieve delivery across the stratum corneum and provide systemic exposure to reach the parathyroid cell. To date, the art has not demonstrated whether a calcimimetic compound can be delivered transdermally in an amount sufficient for therapeutic benefit and in particular in an amount sufficient for decreasing PTH and/or the treatment, attenuation, lessening and/or relief hypercalcemia.
  • Vitamin D analogs act by facilitating intestinal absorption of dietary calcium, and reduce PTH levels by inhibiting PTH synthesis and secretion.
  • vitamin D analogs such as ZEMPLARTM (paricalcitol), CALCIJEX® (calcitriol), ONE-ALPHA® (alfacalcidol) and HECTOROL® (doxercalciferol) can be delivered transdermally in an amount sufficient for therapeutic benefit and in particular in an amount sufficient for decreasing parathyroid hormone (PTH).
  • ZEMPLARTM paricalcitol
  • CALCIJEX® calcitriol
  • ONE-ALPHA® alfacalcidol
  • HECTOROL® doxercalciferol
  • the calcimimetic agents may be administered across the stratum corneum, and/or other layers of the epidermis, for local or systemic delivery, for decreasing parathyroid hormone (PTH) and/or treating hypercalcemia.
  • the calcimimetic agent is delivered via microporation. Any one of a number of techniques for microporation is contemplated, and several are briefly described.
  • Microporation can be achieved by mechanical means and/or external driving forces, to breach the stratum corneum to deliver the calcimimetic agents described herein through the surface of the skin and into the underlying skin layers and/or the bloodstream.
  • the microporation technique is ablation of the stratum corneum in a specific region of the skin using a pulsed laser light of wavelength, pulse length, pulse energy, pulse number, and pulse repetition rate sufficient to ablate the stratum corneum without significantly damaging the underlying epidermis.
  • the calcimimetic agent is then applied to the region of ablation.
  • Another laser ablation microporation technique referred to as laser-induced stress waves (LISW)
  • LISW involves broadband, unipolar and compressible waves generated by high-power pulsed lasers.
  • the LISWs interact with tissues to disrupt the lipids in the stratum corneum, creating intercellular channels transiently within the stratum corneum. These channel, or micropores, in the stratum corneum permit entry of the calcimimetic agent.
  • Sonophoresis or phonophoresis is another microporation technique that uses ultrasound energy.
  • Ultrasound is a sound wave possessing frequencies above 20 KHz. Ultrasound can be applied either continuously or pulsed, and applied at various frequency and intensity ranges (Nanda et al., Current Drug Delivery, 3:233 (2006)).
  • microporation technique involves the use of a microneedle array.
  • the array of microneedles when applied to a skin region on a subject pierce the stratum corneum and do not penetrate to a depth that significantly stimulates nerves or punctures capillaries. The patient, thus, feels no or minimal discomfort or pain upon application of the microneedle array for generation of micropores through which the calcimimetic agent is delivered.
  • Microneedle arrays comprised of hollow or solid microneedles are contemplated, where the calcimimetic agent can be coated on the external surface of the needles or dispensed from the interior of hollow needles. Examples of microneedle arrays are described, for example, in Nanda et al., Current Drug Delivery, 3:233 (2006) and Meidan et al. American J. Therapeutics, 11:312 (2004). First generation microneedle arrays were comprised of solid, silicon microneedles that were externally coated with a therapeutic agent. When the microarray of needles was pressed against the skin and removed after about 10 seconds, the permeation of the agent on the needles into the body was readily achieved.
  • Second generation microneedle arrays were comprised of microneedles of solid or hollow silicon, polycarbonate, titanium or other suitable polymer and coated or filled with a solution of the therapeutic compound. Newer generations of microneedle arrays are prepared from biodegradable polymers, where the tips of the needles coated with a therapeutic agent remain in the stratum corneum and slowly dissolve.
  • the microneedles can be constructed from a variety of materials, including metals, ceramics, semiconductors, organics, polymers, and composites.
  • Exemplary materials of construction include pharmaceutical grade stainless steel, gold, titanium, nickel, iron, tin, chromium, copper, palladium, platinum, alloys of these or other metals, silicon, silicon dioxide, and polymers.
  • biodegradable polymers include polymers of hydroxy acids such as lactic acid and glycolic acid polylactide, polyglycolide, polylactide-co-glycolide, and copolymers with poly(ethylene glycol), polyanhydrides, poly(ortho)esters, polyurethanes, poly(butyric acid), poly(valeric acid), and poly(lactide-co-caprolactone).
  • Representative non-biodegradable polymers include polycarbonate, polyester, and polyacrylamides.
  • the microneedles can have straight or tapered shafts.
  • the diameter of the microneedle is greatest at the base end of the microneedle and tapers to a point at the end distal the base.
  • the microneedle can also be fabricated to have a shaft that includes both a straight (untapered) portion and a tapered portion.
  • the needles may also not have a tapered end at all, i.e. they may simply be cylinders with blunt or flat tips.
  • a hollow microneedle that has a substantially uniform diameter, but which does not taper to a point, is referred to herein as a “microtube.”
  • the term “microneedle” includes both microtubes and tapered needles unless otherwise indicated.
  • Electroporation is another technique for creating micropores in the skin. This approach uses the application of microsecond or millisecond long high-voltage electrical pulses to created transient, permeable pores within the stratum corneum.
  • microporation techniques include use of radio waves to create microchannels in the skin.
  • Thermal ablation is yet another approach to achieve delivery of larger molecular weight compounds transdermally.
  • calcimimetic agents may be therapeutically administered over an extended period of time to treat SHPT. This markedly differs from current dose requirements of other calcimimetics (e.g., cinacalcet hydrochloride).
  • Ac-crrrrrr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO: 6) has been shown to effectively reduce PTH levels from baseline in the 1K1C rat model of acute renal insufficiency when administered by short IV infusion as well as in normal rats (data not shown).
  • the compound Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:3) was administered micropore-facilitated transdermal delivery to normal rats using a transdermal patch.
  • a transdermal patch system containing 10% solution (by weight) of Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:3) in saline was placed over the microporated area and left in place for ⁇ 30 hours. Blood draws were taken from the rats periodically over the 30 hours and plasma samples were analyzed for PTH levels by ELISA. The results are shown in FIG. 12 .
  • CKD stage 4
  • SHPT secondary hyperparathyroidism
  • the PTH lowering effect was further evaluated in the rat 1K1C model of acute renal insufficiency.
  • 1K1C model rats were intravenously infused with low doses of Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:3) (30 ⁇ g/kg/hr and 100 ⁇ g/kg/hr) for 6 hours. Blood samples were taken prior to dosing (Pre), and at 2 hours, 4 hours, 6 hours (just prior to the end of infusion; EOI), 8 hours (2 hrs post EOI) and 24 hours after the start of infusion and plasma was analyzed for PTH levels by ELISA. The data shown in FIG.
  • the methods of use may be used alone or in combination with other approaches for the treatment of hypercalcemia and/or bone disease.
  • Such other approaches include, but are not limited to, treatment with agents such as bisphosphonate agents, integrin blockers, hormone replacement therapy, selective estrogen receptor modulators, cathepsin K inhibitors, vitamin D therapy, vitamin D analogs, such as ZEMPLARTM (paricalcitol), CALCIJEX® (calcitriol), ONE-ALPHA® (alfacalcidol) and HECTOROL® (doxercalciferol), anti-inflammatory agents, low dose PTH therapy (with or without estrogen), calcimimetics, phosphate binders, calcitonin, inhibitors of RANK ligand, antibodies against RANK ligand, osteoprotegrin, adensosine antagonists and ATP proton pump inhibitors.
  • agents such as bisphosphonate agents, integrin blockers, hormone replacement therapy, selective estrogen receptor modulators, cathepsin K inhibitors,
  • a combination therapy uses vitamin D or a vitamin D analog in combination with a calcimimetic agent.
  • Vitamin D aids in the absorption of calcium and functions to maintain normal blood levels of calcium and phosphorous.
  • PTH works to enhance calcium absorption in the intestine by increasing the production of 1,25-(OH) 2 vitamin D, the active form of vitamin D. PTH also stimulates phosphorus excretion from the kidney, and increases release from bone.
  • secondary hyperparathyroidism is characterized by an elevation in parathyroid hormone (PTH) associated with inadequate levels of active vitamin D hormone.
  • Vitamin D or a vitamin D analog may be used to reduce elevated PTH levels in treatment of secondary hyperparathryoidism.
  • the invention includes a pharmaceutical composition comprising a calcimimetic agent and a vitamin D analog.
  • the invention includes a pharmaceutical composition
  • a pharmaceutical composition comprising a calcimimetic agent and ZEMPLARTM (paricalcitol).
  • Paricalcitol is a synthetic analog of calcitriol, the metabolically active form of vitamin D.
  • the recommended initial dose of Zemplar is based on baseline intact parathyroid hormone (iPTH) levels. If the baseline iPTH level is less than or equal to 500 ⁇ g/mL, the daily dose is 1 ⁇ g and the “three times a week” dose (to be administered not more than every other day) is 2 ⁇ g.
  • the baseline iPTH is greater than 500 ⁇ g/mL
  • the daily dose is 2 ⁇ g
  • the “three times a week” does (to be administered not more than every other day) is 4 ⁇ g.
  • dosing must be individualized and based on serum plasma iPTH levels, with monitoring of serum calcium and serum phosphorus. Paricalcitol is described in U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,246,925 and 5,587,497.
  • the invention includes a pharmaceutical composition comprising a calcimimetic agent and CALCIJEX® (calcitriol).
  • Calcitriol is the metabolically active form of vitamin D.
  • the recommended initial dosage for CALCIJEX® (oral) is 0.25 ⁇ /day. This amount may be increased by 0.25 ⁇ g/day at 4- to 8-wk intervals. Normal or only slightly reduced calcium levels may respond to dosages of 0.25 ⁇ g every other day.
  • the recommended initial dose for CALCIJEX® (IV) is 0.02 ⁇ g/kg (1 to 2 ⁇ g) 3 times/week, every other day. This amount may be increased by 0.5 to 1 ⁇ g, every 2 to 4 wk.
  • Calcitriol is described in U.S. Pat. Nos. 6,051,567 and 6,265,392 and 6,274,169.
  • a pharmaceutical composition comprising a calcimimetic agent and HECTOROL® (doxercalciferol) is provided.
  • Doxercalciferol is a synthetic analog of vitamin D that undergoes metabolic activation in vivo to form 1 ⁇ ,25-dihydroxyvitamin D 2 , a naturally occurring, biologically active form of vitamin D.
  • the recommended initial dose of HECTOROL® is 10 ⁇ g administered three times weekly at dialysis (approximately every other day). The initial dose should be adjusted, as needed, in order to lower blood iPTH into the range of 150 to 300 ⁇ g/mL. The dose may be increased at 8-week intervals by 2.5 ⁇ g if iPTH is not lowered by 50% and fails to reach target range.
  • HECTOROL The maximum recommended dose of HECTOROL is 20 ⁇ g administered three times a week at dialysis for a total of 60 ⁇ g per week.
  • Doxercalciferol is described in U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,602,116 and 5,861,386 and 5,869,473 and 6,903,083.
  • the particular combination of therapies (therapeutics or procedures) to employ in a combination regimen will take into account compatibility of the desired therapeutics and/or procedures and the desired therapeutic effect to be achieved. It will also be appreciated that the therapies employed may achieve a desired effect for the same disorder (for example, an inventive compound may be administered concurrently with another agent used to treat the same disorder), or they may achieve different effects (e.g., control of any adverse effects). As used herein, additional therapeutic agents that are normally administered to treat or prevent a particular disease, or condition, are known as “appropriate for the disease, or condition, being treated”.
  • a combination treatment of the present invention as defined herein may be achieved by way of the simultaneous, sequential or separate administration of the individual components of said treatment.
  • compositions for coating implantable medical devices may also be incorporated into compositions for coating implantable medical devices, bio-erodible polymers, implantable pump, and suppositories.
  • a composition for coating an implantable device comprising a described compound as described generally above is contemplated, and a carrier suitable for coating the implantable device.
  • an implantable device coated with a composition comprising a compound as described generally above, and a carrier suitable for coating said implantable device.
  • Suitable coatings and the general preparation of coated implantable devices are described in U.S. Pat. Nos. 6,099,562; 5,886,026; and 5,304,121.
  • the coatings are typically biocompatible polymeric materials such as a hydrogel polymer, polymethyldisiloxane, polycaprolactone, polyethylene glycol, polylactic acid, ethylene vinyl acetate, and mixtures thereof.
  • the coatings may optionally be further covered by a suitable topcoat of fluorosilicone, polysaccarides, polyethylene glycol, phospholipids or combinations thereof to impart controlled release characteristics in the composition.
  • Determination of the effectiveness of a described method of treatment may be determined by a variety of methods.
  • Normal levels of serum calcium are in the range of 8.8 mg/dL to 10.4 mg/dL (2.2 mmol/L to 2.6 mmol/L).
  • the efficacy of treatment may be determined by measurement of serum and urinary markers related to calcium, including but not limited to, total and ionized serum calcium, albumin, plasma PTH, PTHrP, phosphate, vitamin D, and magnesium.
  • efficacy may be determined by measurement of bone mineral density (BMD), or by measurement of biochemical markers for bone formation and/or bone resorption in serum or urine.
  • BMD bone mineral density
  • biochemical markers include, but are not limited to, total alkaline phosphatase, bone alkaline phosphatase, osteocalcin, under-carboxylated osteocalcin, C-terminal procollagen type I propeptide, and N-terminal procollagen type I propeptide.
  • Potential bone resorption markers include, but are not limited, hydroxyproline, hydroxylysine, glycosyl-galactosyl hydroxylysine, galactosyl hydroxylysine, pyridinoline, deoxypyridinoline, N-terminal crosslinking telopeptide of type I collagen, C-terminal crosslinking telopeptide of type I collagen, C-terminal crosslinking telopeptide of type I collagen generated by MMPs, bone sialoprotein, acid phosphatase and tartrate-resistant acid phosphatase.
  • efficacy may be determined by the percent reduction in PTH relative to a pre-dosing (baseline) level and/or by achieving a desirable PTH level as generally accepted as being beneficial to patients (for example, guidelines established by the National Kidney Foundation). Still in other cases, efficacy may be determined by measurement of the reduction in parathyroid gland hyperplasia associated with a hyperparathyroidism disease.
  • the method of treatment will produce an effect, as measured by, for example, one or more of: total serum calcium, ionized serum calcium, total blood calcium, ionized blood calcium, albumin, plasma PTH, blood PTH, PTHrP, phosphate, vitamin D, magnesium, bone mineral density (BMD), total alkaline phosphatase, bone alkaline phosphatase, osteocalcin, under carboxylated osteocalcin, C-terminal procollagen type I propeptide, N-terminal procollagen type I propeptide, hydroxyproline, hydroxylysine, glycosyl-galactosyl hydroxylysine, galactosyl hydroxylysine, pyridinoline, deoxypyridinoline, N-terminal crosslinking telopeptide of type I collagen, C-terminal crosslinking telopeptide of type I collagen, C-terminal crosslinking telopeptide of type I collagen, C-terminal crosslinking telopeptide of type
  • a biologically effective molecule may be operably linked to a described peptide with a covalent bond or a non-covalent interaction.
  • the operably linked biologically effective molecules can alter the pharmacokinetics of the described compounds by virtue of conferring properties to the compound as part of a linked molecule.
  • Some of the properties that the biologically effective molecules can confer on the described compounds include, but are not limited to: delivery of a compound to a discrete location within the body; concentrating the activity of a compound at a desired location in the body and reducing its effects elsewhere; reducing side effects of treatment with a compound; changing the permeability of a compound; changing the bioavailability or the rate of delivery to the body of a compound; changing the length of the effect of treatment with a compound; altering the in vitro chemical stability of the compound; altering the in vivo stability of the compound, half-life, clearance, absorption, distribution and/or excretion; altering the rate of the onset and the decay of the effects of a compound; providing a permissive action by allowing a compound to have an effect.
  • the described compound may be conjugated to polyethylene glycol (PEG).
  • PEG polyethylene glycol
  • the selected PEG may be of any convenient molecular weight, and may be linear or branched, and may be optionally conjugated through a linker.
  • the average molecular weight of PEG will preferably range from about 2 kiloDalton (kDa) to about 100 kDa, more preferably from about 5 kDa to about 40 kDa.
  • the PEG moiety used can be 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, or 20 kDa.
  • the described compounds may be conjugated to PEG through a suitable amino acid residue located at any position on the compounds.
  • the described compounds may optionally contain an additional amino acid residue to which PEG is conjugated, including for example, an additional amine-containing residue, such as lysine.
  • PEGylated peptides are known in the art to increase serum half-life of conjugated peptide.
  • a variety of methods are known in the art for the formation of PEGylated peptides.
  • the PEG moiety can be linked to the amino terminus, the carboxy terminus or through a side chain of the claimed peptide, optionally through the presence of a linking group.
  • the PEG moiety may be linked to the sulfur of a thiol-containing amino acid, such as cysteine, or may be coupled to the sidechain of an amine-containing amino acid, such as lysine.
  • the PEG groups will generally be attached to the described compound by acylation or alkylation through a reactive group on the PEG moiety (e.g., an aldehyde, amine, oxime, hydrazine thiol, ester, or carboxylic acid group) to a reactive group on the described compound (e.g., an aldehyde, amine, oxime, hydrazine, ester, acid or thiol group), which may be located at the amino terminus, carboxy terminus, or a sidechain position of the described compound.
  • a reactive group on the PEG moiety e.g., an aldehyde, amine, oxime, hydrazine thiol, ester, or carboxylic acid group
  • a reactive group on the described compound e.g., an aldehyde, amine, oxime, hydrazine, ester, acid or thiol group
  • PEGylation of synthetic peptides consists of combining through a conjugate linkage in solution, a peptide and a PEG moiety, each bearing a functional group that is mutually reactive towards the other.
  • Peptides can be easily prepared using conventional solution or solid phase synthesis techniques. Conjugation of the peptide and PEG is typically done in aqueous phase and may be monitored by reverse phase HPLC.
  • the PEGylated peptides can be readily purified and characterized, using standard techniques known to one of skill in the art.
  • One or more individual subunits of the described compounds may also be modified with various derivatizing agents known to react with specific side chains or terminal residues.
  • lysinyl residues and amino terminal residues may be reacted with succinic anhydride or other similar carboxylic acid anhydrides which reverses the charge on the lysinyl or amino residue.
  • suitable reagents include, e.g., imidoesters such as methyl picolinimidate; pyridoxal; pyridoxal phosphate; chloroborohydride; trinitrobenzenesulfonic acid; O-methylisourea, 2,4,-pentanedione; and transaminase-catalyzed reaction with glyoxalate.
  • Arginyl residues may be modified by reaction with conventional agents such as phenylglyoxal, 2,3-butanedione, 1,2-cyclohexanedione, and ninhydrin.
  • the described compounds may be modified to include non-cationic residues that provide immunogenic residues useful for the development of antibodies for bioanalytical ELISA measurements, as well as to evaluate immunogenicity.
  • the described compounds may be modified by incorporation of tyrosine and/or glycine residues. Specific modifications of tyrosyl residues are of particular interest for introducing spectral labels into tyrosyl residues. Non-limiting examples include reaction with aromatic diazonium compounds or tetranitromethane. Most commonly, N-acetylimidazole and tetranitromethane are used to form O-acetyl tyrosyl and 3-nitro derivatives, respectively.
  • kits for carrying out the therapeutic regimens of the invention comprise therapeutically effective amounts of the described compounds having activity as a CaSR modulator, in pharmaceutically acceptable form, alone or in combination with other agents, in pharmaceutically acceptable form.
  • Preferred pharmaceutical forms include the described compounds in combination with sterile saline, dextrose solution, buffered solution, sterile water, or other pharmaceutically acceptable sterile fluid.
  • the composition may include an antimicrobial or bacteriostatic agent.
  • the composition may be lyophilized or desiccated.
  • the kit may further comprise a pharmaceutically acceptable solution, preferably sterile, to form a solution for injection purposes.
  • the kit may further comprise a needle or syringe, preferably packaged in sterile form, for injecting the composition.
  • the kit further comprises an instruction means for administering the composition to a subject.
  • the instruction means can be a written insert, an audiotape, an audiovisual tape, or any other means of instructing the administration of the composition to a subject.
  • the kit comprises (i) a first container containing a described compound having activity as a CaSR modulator; and (ii) instruction means for use.
  • the kit comprises (i) a first container containing a compound as described herein, and (ii) a second container containing a pharmaceutically acceptable vehicle for dilution or reconstitution.
  • the kit comprises (i) a first container containing a described compound having activity as a CaSR modulator; (ii) a second container containing an anticalcemic agent; and (iii) instruction means for use.
  • the anticalcemic agent is and agent selected from the group consisting of bisphosphonate agents, hormone replacement therapeutic agents, vitamin D therapy, vitamin D analogs, such as ZEMPLARTM (paricalcitol); CALCIJEX® (calcitriol), ONE-ALPHA® (alfacalcidol) and HECTOROL® (doxercalciferol), low dose PTH (with or without estrogen), and calcitonin.
  • bisphosphonate agents such as ZEMPLARTM (paricalcitol); CALCIJEX® (calcitriol), ONE-ALPHA® (alfacalcidol) and HECTOROL® (doxercalciferol), low dose PTH (with or without estrogen), and calcitonin.
  • the invention provides articles of manufacture that comprise the contents of the kits described above.
  • the invention provides an article of manufacture comprising an effective amount of a described peptide, alone or in combination with other agents, and instruction means indicating use for treating diseases described herein.
  • a rat model of acute renal insufficiency (also referred to as the 1K1C model) was developed to simulate the pathology of SHPT associated with end stage renal disease.
  • the model exhibits pathological characteristics of hyper parathyroidsm associated with a lack of renal function, specifically the significant elevation of plasma PTH and reduction in serum calcium.
  • the development of this model allowed for the further characterization of described compounds in the context of a subject with renal dysfunction and elevated PTH. Typical baseline PTH levels in this model averaged ⁇ 450 ⁇ g/mL.
  • the 1K1C model of acute renal insufficiency involves the removal of one kidney followed by exposure of the remaining kidney to 45 minutes of ischemia and 48 hours of reperfusion.
  • the ensuing ischemia/reperfusion (I/R) damage to the remaining kidney results in significant necrosis and renal failure.
  • Serum creatinine levels were elevated for over 24-48 hours following I/R insult (data not shown).
  • total PTH levels are dramatically increased from the pre-I/R injury levels of ⁇ 100 ⁇ g/mL.
  • plasma PTH levels were elevated to ⁇ 450 ⁇ g/mL ( ⁇ 5 fold increase) and in some instances reach as high as ⁇ 1200 ⁇ g/mL.
  • Cinacalcet hydrochloride SENSIPAR®
  • SENSIPAR® an approved calcimimetic agent that is used to lower PTH for the treatment of SHPT
  • Oral administration of cinacalcet at 30 mg/kg significantly lowered PTH by approximately 50% for up to 6 hours. This result is consistent with the published preclinical data for cinacalcet (Nemeth et al., J. Pharmacol. Exp. Ther., 308(2):627-35 (2004)) and validates that the 1K1C model of acute renal insufficiency is an appropriate model for evaluating the activity of calcimimetics for this indication.
  • mice Male Sprague Dawley rats were purchased from Charles River Laboratories (Hollister, Calif.; requested purchase weight 250-275 g).
  • animals were pre-cannulated in the femoral and jugular veins for drug administration and blood draws, respectively. Animals were maintained in a temperature-controlled environment with a constant 12 hours light/12 hours dark cycle and free access to food and water at all times. All experimental procedures with animals were performed according to IACUC guidelines.
  • IP intraperitoneal
  • the left femoral vein was cannulated with a PE-10 tube for blood drawing. Both kidneys were exposed via a laparotomy. A right nephrectomy was performed after the right renal pedicle and ureter were ligated with double 2-0 silk sutures. After confirmation of non-bleeding in the right pedicle, the left renal artery was carefully dissected and clamped with a micro vascular clip to induce left renal global ischemia. Renal ischemia was confirmed by observation of a global white-grey color change (blanching). The abdominal incision was temporarily covered with gauze to help maintain the temperature of the abdominal organs.
  • test articles were administered by IV infusion (infusion time 5, 10 or 30 minutes) although in some studies compounds were administered by IV bolus or subcutaneous (SC) bolus injection.
  • SC subcutaneous
  • Serum samples were collected periodically throughout the course of the study. Serum samples were analyzed for of calcium levels and plasma samples were analyzed for PTH. Due to the range of baseline PTH values for individual rats, all data are normalized to pre-dosing (baseline) levels. Serum creatinine was measured using a commercially available kit from BioAssay Systems (Hayward, Ca), catalog #DICT-500. Analyses were performed according to the manufacturer's instructions.
  • HEK 293T cells Human embryonic kidney (HEK) 293T cells were seeded into a T25 flask at 2 million cells per flask and allowed to incubate at 37° C. in 5% CO 2 overnight. The day after, these cells were transfected with human CaSR receptor using lipofectamine 2000 transfection reagent 24 hrs post transfection, cells were seeded in 384 well plates at 8,000 cells/well. Assays were carried out 48 hours after the transfection. In some cases, EC 50 values were determined by measuring inositol monophosphate production in the HEK293 cells, stably transfected with the human calcium-sensing receptor (see Table 1).
  • the cell culture medium was aspirated from the wells and replaced with 28 ⁇ L of 1 ⁇ stimulation buffer (Hepes 10 mM, CaCl 2 ) 1 mM, MgCl2 0.5 mM, KCl 4.2 mM, NaCl 146 mM, glucose 5.5 mM, LiCl 50 mM pH 7.4). Cells were incubated with compounds at various concentrations (1 mM or 300 ⁇ M as the highest and further 1 ⁇ 2 log serial dilutions) at 37° C. for 1.5 hrs before reaction termination. IP 1 production was determined in cells using the Cisbio IP-One Tb kit (621PAPEC) and according to manufacturer instructions.
  • IP 1 concentrations were calculated from standard curves (generated with Graph Pad Prism ver. 4) using known concentrations of IP 1 standards.
  • EC 50 s were calculated based on the values of the fluorescent ratio OD(668 nm)/(OD620 nm) using non-linear regression curve fitting in Prism software.
  • Peptides and conjugates were prepared by solid-phase chemistry at 0.25 mmol scale on an ABI automated synthesizer. Sequential coupling of Fmoc-amino acids (4 eq, Anaspec) to Rink-amide resin (NovaBiochem) was accomplished using HBTU/DIEA activation. The assembled peptide was cleaved with a TFA cocktail (phenol (5%), triisopropylsilane (2.5%) and water (2.5%); 10 mL per gram of resin) and isolated by precipitation with diethyl ether. After purification by C 18 HPLC the final product was isolated in the TFA salt form by lyophilization of appropriate fractions, and characterized by HPLC (>95% purity) and LC-MS (confirmed MVV).
  • the peptides were administered intravenously at a dose of 0.5 mg/kg into isoflurane-anesthetized normal Sprague Dawley rats.
  • a control group of rats was treated with saline. Blood was drawn prior to dosing and every hour for 4 hours. Rats were maintained under isoflurane anesthesia for the entire study.
  • the concentration of PTH in the plasma was measured by ELISA, detecting the bioactive intact PTH 1-84 (Immutopics International catalog number 60-2700), and the cumulative area under the curve for AUC was calculated for the data points inclusive of 1-4 hours. Percent PTH reduction was calculated according to the following formula: AUC cmpd treated /AUC saline control *100.
  • the peptides tested identified herein as SEQ ID NO: 26 (Ac-carrrar-NH 2 ) and as SEQ ID NO:29 (Ac-arrrar-NH 2 ) were tested in vitro using the HEK293 CaSR transfected cells, according to the procedure in Example 2.
  • the peptides were also tested in vivo, by administering as an IV bolus to normal Sprague Dawley rats at doses of 9 mg/kg for SEQ ID NO:29 and at 0.5 mg/kg for SEQ ID NO: 26.
  • An intravenous (IV) bolus of saline was used as a control.
  • Plasma (K 2 EDTA) PTH levels were assessed prior to dosing and 1, 2, 3 and 4 hours after dosing. Rats were maintained under isoflurane anesthesia for the entire study. The results are shown in FIGS. 2A-2B , presented as group average ⁇ standard deviation (SD). In FIG. 2B , PTH is shown as percent of the baseline pre
  • a series of compounds having an L-amino acid residue substituted for a D-amino acid residue were prepared.
  • the compounds were administered as an IV bolus to normal Sprague Dawley rats at a dose of 0.5 mg/kg.
  • An intravenous (IV) bolus of saline was used as a control.
  • Plasma (K 2 EDTA) PTH levels were assessed prior to dosing and 1, 2, 3 and 4 hours after dosing, and the AUC was calculated as described above. Rats were maintained under isoflurane anesthesia for the entire study. The results are shown in Table 4 above.
  • peptides containing 4 to 7 cationic (arginine) residues were generated and tested for their ability to trigger histamine release in vivo.
  • the tested peptides included (i) Ac-crrrr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:4), (ii) Ac-crrrr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:5), (iii) Ac-crrrrr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:6) and (iv) Ac-crrrrrrrrr-NH 2 ; SEQ ID NO:41).
  • Histamine ELISAs were performed on diluted plasma using the Histamine Enzyme Immunoassay (EIA) kit (Cat #A05890, SPI-BIO, Montigny le Bretonneux, France).
  • the Histamine EIA kit is a derivitization-amplified competitive enzyme immunoassay which detects histamine within the range of 40 ⁇ g/mL to 5,500 ⁇ g/mL. The samples were analyzed in duplicate according to the manufacturer's protocol.
  • Lyophilized peptides (TFA salts) were weighed and the recorded mass was adjusted for peptide content. Solutions were prepared by dissolving the material in normal saline to generate the desired peptide concentration. In some cases the molarity of peptide was adjusted to allow for inter-peptide comparison.
  • isolated rat peritoneal mast cells were isolated by performing peritoneal lavage using cold HBSS+25 mM HEPES pH 7.4 containing heparin (5 u/mL). Cells were washed twice in stimulation buffer (HBSS+25 mM HEPES pH 7.4) and incubated with 10 ⁇ M of compound in stimulation buffer (HBSS+25 mM HEPES pH 7.4) for 15 minutes in a 96-well plate (10 6 /well) at 37° C. Cell supernatant was analyzed for histamine using histamine EIA kit (Cayman #589651). Data is shown in Table 10.
  • the compound Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:3) was prepared for comparison with the compound Ac-carrrar-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:26).
  • the thiol-containing subunit in position X 1 is conjugated via a disulfide linkage to an L-Cys residue.
  • the two compounds were administered via IV bolus to animals with the 1K1C model of acute renal insufficiency at doses of 0.3 and 0.5 mg/kg. Plasma PTH levels were assessed prior to dosing and periodically for 24 hours after dosing. Results are shown in FIG.
  • Ac-crrrrrr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:6) was administered to CD hairless rats transdermally using a reservoir.
  • Ac-crrrrrr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:6) was applied as a 10% solution in saline to an approximately 1 cm 2 area on the back of CD® hairless rats that were microporated by 5 passes of a 1.0 mm Derma Roller under moderate pressure.
  • a polystyrene chamber (I.D. 9.5 mm) was glued over the microporated area of skin to create a drug reservoir in which the solution of either Ac-crrrrrr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO: 6) or a saline solution were applied.
  • a 10% solution of Ac-crrrrrr-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO: 6) was administered in the reservoir chamber on two rats, a saline solution alone was administered in the reservoir chamber on one rat.
  • the reservoirs were covered with tape to prevent evaporation. Blood draws were taken over a 4 hour period and plasma was analyzed for PTH levels by ELISA. The results are shown in FIG. 11 .
  • Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:3) was administered transdermally to normal rats using a transdermal patch.
  • Normal rats were treated with microneedle array and transdermal patch system.
  • a small area of fur on the back of Sprague Dawley rats ( ⁇ 350 g) was sheared using clippers and an area of skin was microporated using a 14 ⁇ 14 array ( ⁇ 1 cm 2 ) of microneedles ( ⁇ 0.5 mm).
  • a transdermal patch system containing 10% solution (by weight) of Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO:3) in saline was placed over the microporated area and left in place for ⁇ 30 hours. Blood draws were taken from the rats periodically over the 30 hours and plasma samples was analyzed for PTH levels by ELISA. The results are shown in FIG. 12 .
  • 1K1C model rats were intravenously infused with Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH 2 (SEQ ID NO: 273 at dose rates of 30 ⁇ g/kg/hr and 100 ⁇ g/kg/hr for 6 hours.
  • Blood samples were taken prior to dosing (Pre), at 2 hours, 4 hours, 6 hours (just prior to the end of infusion; EOI), 8 hours (2 hrs post EOI) and 24 hours and plasma was analyzed for PTH levels by ELISA.
  • the data are shown in FIG. 14A (30 ⁇ g/kg/hr, diamonds, and 100 ⁇ g/kg/hr, squares) and the serum calcium for the animals is shown in FIG. 14B .

Landscapes

  • Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
  • Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
  • Organic Chemistry (AREA)
  • Medicinal Chemistry (AREA)
  • General Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
  • Life Sciences & Earth Sciences (AREA)
  • Veterinary Medicine (AREA)
  • Animal Behavior & Ethology (AREA)
  • Public Health (AREA)
  • Pharmacology & Pharmacy (AREA)
  • Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
  • Bioinformatics & Cheminformatics (AREA)
  • Proteomics, Peptides & Aminoacids (AREA)
  • Molecular Biology (AREA)
  • Biochemistry (AREA)
  • Biophysics (AREA)
  • Genetics & Genomics (AREA)
  • Epidemiology (AREA)
  • Nuclear Medicine, Radiotherapy & Molecular Imaging (AREA)
  • Chemical Kinetics & Catalysis (AREA)
  • General Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
  • Diabetes (AREA)
  • Endocrinology (AREA)
  • Dermatology (AREA)
  • Hematology (AREA)
  • Urology & Nephrology (AREA)
  • Obesity (AREA)
  • Rheumatology (AREA)
  • Medicines That Contain Protein Lipid Enzymes And Other Medicines (AREA)
  • Peptides Or Proteins (AREA)
  • Pharmaceuticals Containing Other Organic And Inorganic Compounds (AREA)
  • Acyclic And Carbocyclic Compounds In Medicinal Compositions (AREA)
  • Medicinal Preparation (AREA)
  • Organic Low-Molecular-Weight Compounds And Preparation Thereof (AREA)

Abstract

Compounds having activity for lowering parathyroid hormone levels are described. In one embodiment, the compounds are comprised of a contiguous sequence of subunits, X1-X2-X3-X4-X5-X6-X7, wherein the X1 subunit comprises a thiol-containing moiety and the distribution of charge on the X2-X7 subunits provides the desired activity. Methods of using the compounds for treating hyperparathyroidism, bone disease and/or hypercalcemic disorders are also described, and in particular, methods for lowering plasma PTH and serum calcium are provided. The compounds can be used to treat subjects having, for example: primary, secondary or tertiary hyperparathyroidism; hypercalcemia of malignancy; metastatic bone disease; or osteoporosis.

Description

    CROSS-REFERENCE TO RELATED APPLICATIONS
  • This application is a continuation of U.S. application Ser. No. 16/298,902, filed Mar. 11, 2019, pending, which is a continuation of U.S. application Ser. No. 15/629,536, filed Jun. 21, 2017, now U.S. Pat. No. 10,280,198, which is a continuation of U.S. application Ser. No. 15/018,567, filed Feb. 8, 2016, now U.S. Pat. No. 9,701,712, which is a continuation of U.S. application Ser. No. 13/769,744, filed Feb. 18, 2013, now U.S. Pat. No. 9,278,995, which is a continuation of U.S. application Ser. No. 13/365,213, filed Feb. 2, 2012, now U.S. Pat. No. 8,377,880, which is a continuation-in-part of U.S. application Ser. No. 12/846,724, filed Jul. 29, 2010, now U.S. Pat. No. 8,999,932 which claims the benefit of U.S. Provisional Application No. 61/229,695, filed Jul. 29, 2009, and of U.S. Provisional Application No. 61/255,816, filed Oct. 28, 2009, and of U.S. Provisional Application No. 61/313,635, filed Mar. 12, 2010. Each of these applications is incorporated herein by reference in its entirety.
  • REFERENCE TO SEQUENCE LISTING
  • A Sequence Listing is being submitted electronically via EFS in the form of a text file, created Sep. 1, 2020, and named “SEQ.txt” (88,084 bytes), the contents of which are incorporated herein by reference in their entirety.
  • TECHNICAL FIELD
  • The current subject matter relates to compounds with activity to decrease parathyroid hormone (PTH) levels, to pharmaceutical compositions comprising the compounds, and to the use of such compounds and compositions in methods of treatment, including but not limited to treating hypercalcemia or hyperparathyroidism or modulating in vivo PTH levels.
  • BACKGROUND
  • Calcium homeostasis is the mechanism by which the body maintains adequate calcium levels. The process is highly regulated, and involves a complex interplay between calcium absorption, transport, storage in bones, deposition in other tissues, and excretion. PTH is a regulator of circulating calcium levels, and functions to increase the concentration of calcium in the blood by enhancing the release of calcium from bone through the process of bone resorption; increasing reabsorption of calcium from the renal tubules; and enhancing calcium absorption in the intestine by increasing the production of 1,25-(OH)2 vitamin D, the active form of vitamin D. PTH also stimulates phosphorus excretion from the kidney, and increases release from bone.
  • PTH secretion is regulated by the calcium sensing receptor (CaSR), a G-protein coupled receptor expressed by several cell types on the surface of parathyroid cells, which detects small fluctuations in the concentration of extracellular calcium ion (Ca2+) and responds by altering the secretion of PTH. Activation of the CaSR by Ca2+ inhibits PTH secretion within seconds to minutes through inhibition of vesicular transport, and this process may be modulated by protein kinase C (PKC) phosphorylation of the receptor. The CaSR is also expressed on osteoblasts and in the kidney, where it regulates renal Ca2+ excretion.
  • In addition, PTH regulates phosphorus homeostasis. PTH stimulates the parathyroid hormone receptor 1 (PTHR1) on both apical (brush border membrane) and basolateral membranes of cells in the GI tract. PTHR1 stimulation leads to an increase in urinary excretion of phosphate (Pi) as a consequence of reduction by internalization of the renal Na+/phosphate (NaPi-IIa) co-transporter on the brush border membrane.
  • PTH is also involved in the regulation of osteoblasts and osteoclasts in bone. PTH increases circulating Ca2+ by increasing bone resorption and renal reabsorption of calcium. PTH stimulates osteoblasts to produce RANK ligand (RANKL), which binds to the RANK receptor and activates the osteoclasts, leading to an increase in bone resorption and an increase in serum Ca2+. Osteoprotegerin (OPG) is a decoy receptor for RANKL which blocks bone resorption. Osteoporosis is caused by an imbalance between the processes of bone resorption by osteoclasts and bone formation by osteoblasts.
  • The human body contains approximately 1 kg of calcium, 99% of which resides in bone. Under normal conditions, circulating calcium ion (Ca2+) is tightly maintained at a level of about 9 to 10 mg/dL (i.e., 2.25-2.5 mmol/L; ˜600 mg). Approximately 1 g of elemental calcium (Ca2+) is ingested daily. Of this amount, approximately 200 mg/day is absorbed, and 800 mg/day is excreted. In addition, approximately 500 mg/day is released by bone resorption or is deposited into bone. About 10 g of Ca2+ is filtered through the kidney per day, with about 200 mg appearing in the urine, and the remainder being reabsorbed.
  • Hypercalcemia is an elevated calcium level in the blood. Acute hypercalcemia can result in gastrointestinal (anorexia, nausea, vomiting); renal (polyuria, polydipsia), neuro-muscular (depression, confusion, stupor, coma) and cardiac (bradycardia, first degree atrio-ventricular) symptoms. Chronic hypercalcemia is also associated with gastrointestinal (dyspepsia, constipation, pancreatitis); renal (nephrolithiasis, nephrocalcinosis), neuro-muscular (weakness) and cardiac (hypertension block, digitalis sensitivity) symptoms. Abnormal heart rhythms can result, and EKG findings of a short QT interval and a widened T wave suggest hypercalcemia. Hypercalcemia may be asymptomatic, with symptoms more commonly occurring at high calcium levels (12.0 mg/dL or 3 mmol/l). Severe hypercalcemia (above 15-16 mg/dL or 3.75-4 mmol/l) is considered a medical emergency: at these levels, coma and cardiac arrest can result.
  • Hypercalcemia is frequently caused by hyperparathyroidism, leading to excess bone resorption and elevated levels of serum calcium. In primary sporadic hyperparathyroidism, PTH is overproduced by a single parathyroid adenoma; less commonly, multiple adenomas or diffuse parathyroid gland hyperplasia may be causative. Increased PTH secretion leads to a net increase in bone resorption, with release of Ca2+ and phosphate (Pi). PTH also enhances renal reabsorption of Ca2+ and inhibits reabsorption of phosphate (Pi), resulting in a net increase in serum calcium and a decrease in phosphate.
  • Secondary hyperparathyroidism occurs when a decrease in circulating levels of Ca2+ level stimulates PTH secretion. One cause of secondary hyperparathyroidism is chronic renal insufficiency (also referred to as chronic kidney disease or CKD), such as that in renal polycystic disease or chronic pyelonephritis, or chronic renal failure, such as that in hemodialysis patients (also referred to as end stage renal disease or ESRD). Excess PTH may be produced in response to hypocalcemia resulting from low calcium intake, GI disorders, renal insufficiency, vitamin D deficiency, and renal hypercalciuria. Tertiary hyperparathyroidism may occur after a long period of secondary hyperparathyroidism and hypercalcemia.
  • Malignancy is a common cause of non-PTH mediated hypercalcemia. Hypercalcemia of malignancy, is an uncommon but severe complication of cancer, affecting between 10% and 20% of cancer patients, and may occur with both solid tumors and leukemia. The condition has an abrupt onset and has a very poor prognosis, with a median survival of only six weeks. Growth factors (GF) regulate the production of parathyroid hormone-related protein (PTHrP) in tumor cells. Tumor cells may be stimulated by autocrine GF to increase production of PTHrP, leading to enhanced bone resorption. Tumor cells metastatic to bone may also secrete PTHrP, which can resorb bone and release additional GF which in turn act in a paracrine manner to further enhance PTHrP production.
  • Accordingly, compounds with activity to, for example, modulate PTH levels and/or calcium levels in vivo are desired.
  • BRIEF SUMMARY
  • In one aspect, a compound, comprising the formula

  • X1-X2-X3-X4-X5-X6-X7
  • is provided, wherein X1 is a subunit comprising a thiol-containing group; X5 is a cationic subunit; X6 is a non-cationic subunit; X7 is a cationic subunit; and at least one, preferably two, of X2, X3 and X4 is/are independently a cationic subunit; and wherein the compound has activity to decrease parathyroid hormone concentration. In one embodiment, the decrease in parathyroid hormone concentration is a decrease in blood or plasma parathyroid hormone concentration in a subject treated with the compound relative to the blood or plasma parathyroid hormone concentration in the subject prior to treatment. In another embodiment, the decrease in parathyroid hormone concentration is achieved in the absence of a histamine response.
  • In another embodiment X3 and X4 are non-cationic while X1, X5, X6 and X7 are cationic.
  • In one embodiment, the X1 subunit is a thiol-containing amino acid residue. In another embodiment, the thiol group of the X1 subunit is an organic thiol-containing moiety.
  • In another embodiment, when the X1 subunit is a thiol-containing amino acid residue, it is selected from the group consisting of L-cysteine, D-cysteine, glutathione, n-acetylated cysteine, homocysteine and pegylated cysteine.
  • In yet another embodiment, the organic thiol-containing moiety is selected from thiol-alkyl, or thioacyl moieties such as 3-mercaptopropyl or 3-mercaptopropionyl, mercaptopropionic acid, mercaptoacetic acid, thiobenzyl, or thiopropyl. In still another embodiment, the organic-thiol-containing moiety is mercaptopropionic acid.
  • In still another embodiment, the X1 subunit is modified chemically to comprise an acetyl group, a benzoyl group, a butyl group, or another amino acid such as acetylated-beta-alanine.
  • In yet another embodiment, when the X1 subunit comprises a thiol moiety, the X1 subunit is joined by a covalent linkage to a second thiol moiety.
  • In another embodiment, the formula X1-X2-X3-X4-X5-X6-X7 is comprised of a contiguous sequence of amino acid residues (designated herein as (Xaa1)-(Xaa2)-(Xaa3)-(Xaa4)-(Xaa5)-(Xaa6)-(Xaa7) SEQ ID NO:1) or a sequence of organic compound subunits (non-amino acid residues).
  • In another embodiment, the contiguous sequence of amino acid residues is a contiguous sequence of L-amino acid residues, a contiguous sequence of D-amino acid residues, a contiguous sequence of a mixture of L-amino acid residues and D-amino acid residues, or a mixture of amino acid residues and non-natural amino acid residues.
  • In another embodiment, the contiguous sequence of amino acid residues is linked to a compound to facilitate transport across a cell membrane. In another embodiment, the contiguous sequence of amino acid residues is linked to a compound that enhances delivery of the sequence into or across one or more layers of tissue.
  • In another embodiment, the contiguous sequence of amino acid residues is contained within a sequence of amino acid residues from 8-50 amino acid residues, 8-40 amino acid residues, 8-30 amino acid residues or 8-20 amino acid residues in length. In yet another embodiment, the contiguous sequence of amino acid residues is contained within a sequence of amino acid residues from 8-19 amino acid residues, 8-18 amino acid residues, 8-17 amino acid residues, 8-16 amino acid residues, 8-15 amino acid residues, 8-14 amino acid residues, 8-13 amino acid residues, 8-12 amino acid residues, 8-11 amino acid residues, 8-10 amino acid residues, or 8-9 amino acid residues in length.
  • In another embodiment, the X3 subunit is a cationic amino acid residue.
  • In another embodiment, the X2 subunit is a non-cationic amino acid residue, and in another embodiment, the X4 subunit is a non-cationic amino acid residue. In one embodiment, the non-cationic amino acid residue is a D-amino acid.
  • In another embodiment, X3 and X4 are cationic D-amino acid residues.
  • In another embodiment, the X5 subunit is a D-amino acid residue.
  • In another aspect, the contiguous sequence in any of the described compounds is covalently attached via the thiol-containing group in the X1 subunit to a second contiguous sequence. For example, the second contiguous sequence can be identical to the contiguous sequence (to form a dimer), or can be non-identical, as would be the case when attached to a moiety that facilitates transfer of the contiguous sequence across a cell membrane.
  • In another aspect, a conjugate comprised of the peptide carrrar (SEQ ID NO:2) is provided, where the peptide is conjugated at its N-terminal residue to a Cys residue.
  • In one embodiment, the peptide is chemically modified at the N-terminus, the C-terminus, or both.
  • In another embodiment, the N-terminus of the peptide is chemically modified by acetylation and the C-terminus is chemically modified by amidation.
  • In another embodiment, the conjugate is Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:3).
  • In another aspect, a method of treating secondary hyperparathyroidism (SHPT) in a subject is contemplated, wherein a compound as described herein is provided to the subject. In various embodiments, the subject can be suffering from chronic kidney disease or other condition.
  • In another aspect, a method of decreasing parathyroid hormone in a subject is contemplated, wherein a compound as described herein is provided to the subject.
  • In another aspect, a treatment regimen is provided, the regimen comprising providing a compound according to any of those described herein, in combination with a second agent.
  • In one embodiment, the second therapeutic agent is vitamin D, a vitamin D analog or cinacalcet hydrochloride.
  • In any of the aspects or embodiments described herein, any one or more of the sequences is contemplated to be individually excepted or removed from the scope of the claims. In certain embodiments, the peptides identified by any one or more of SEQ ID NOs: 162-182, individually or in any combination, are excluded from the claimed compounds, compositions and methods.
  • BRIEF DESCRIPTION OF THE DRAWINGS
  • FIG. 1 is a graph of parathyroid hormone level, as percent of the baseline pre-dose value, as a function of time, in hours, in rats with acute renal insufficiency (1K1C model), where the rats were dosed with Ac-crrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:4, diamonds), Ac-crrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:5, closed squares), Ac-crrrrrr-NH2(SEQ ID NO:6, triangles), Ac-crrrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:7, open squares), or saline control (x symbols);
  • FIG. 2A is a graph of IP1 concentration, in nM, as a function of compound concentration of Ac-carrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:26, squares) and Ac-arrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:29, triangles), as a measure of the compound's ability to activate the human CaSR in an in vitro cell assay when the human CaSR is expressed as a stable transfected HEK-293 cell line;
  • FIG. 2B shows the reduction in PTH concentration upon in vivo administration of peptides identified as SEQ ID NO:26 (Ac-carrrar-NH2) (squares) and as SEQ ID NO:29 (Ac-arrrar-NH2) (diamonds), where the peptides were administered as an IV bolus to normal Sprague Dawley rats at doses of 9 mg/kg for SEQ ID NO:29 and at 0.5 mg/kg for SEQ ID NO:26. An intravenous (IV) bolus of saline was used as a control (dashed line). Plasma PTH levels were assessed prior to dosing and 1, 2, 3 and 4 hours after dosing. Results are presented as group average±standard deviation (SD), and PTH is shown as percent of the baseline pre-dose value;
  • FIG. 3 is a bar graph that compares the release of histamine following IV bolus administration of various compounds in normal Sprague Dawley rats, where the compounds Ac-crrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:4), Ac-crrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:5), Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:6) and Ac-crrrrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:41) were dosed in an equimolar IV bolus dose of 2.1 μmol/kg, and plasma histamine was measured before dosing (pre-dose), 5, 15 and 30 minutes after dosing;
  • FIG. 4 is a bar graph that compares the release of histamine following IV bolus administration of two compounds in normal Sprague Dawley rats, where the compounds Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:3, cross hatched bars) and Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:6, open bars) were dosed at 3 mg/kg, and plasma histamine was measured before dosing (time zero) and 5, 15 and 30 minutes after dosing;
  • FIG. 5 is a graph of parathyroid hormone level, as percent of the baseline pre-dose value, as a function of time, in hours, in normal rats dosed with 0.5 mg/kg by IV bolus of Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:6, diamonds), Ac-carrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:8, squares), Ac-crarrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:9, triangles), Ac-crrarrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:10, x symbols), Ac-crrrarr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:11, * symbols), Ac-crrrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:12, circles) or Ac-crrrrra-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:13, + symbols);
  • FIGS. 6A-6B are graphs of parathyroid hormone level, as percent of the baseline pre-dose value, as a function of time, in hours, in healthy rats dosed with 0.5 mg/kg by IV bolus of Ac-carrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:26, open diamonds), Ac-crrarar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:25, open squares), Ac-caarrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:22, triangles), Ac-crraarr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:17, closed squares), Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:3, diamonds FIG. 6B), Ac-craarrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:24, x symbols in FIG. 6A); Ac-c(C)rrarar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:28, x symbols, FIG. 6B);
  • FIG. 7 shows the decrease in parathyroid hormone levels in the blood as a function of time, for the compound Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:3) administered as an IV bolus to normal Sprague Dawley rats at doses of 1 mg/kg (diamonds), 0.5 mg/kg (squares), 0.3 mg/kg (triangles), and 0.1 mg/kg (x symbols). An intravenous (IV) bolus of saline (circles) was used as a control. Plasma PTH levels were assessed prior to dosing and at 1, 2, 3 and 4 hours after dosing.
  • FIG. 8 is a graph of parathyroid hormone level, as percent of the baseline pre-dose value, as a function of time, in hours, in rats with acute renal insufficiency (1K1C model), in rats with 1K1C model of acute renal insufficiency, where the rats were dosed via IV bolus with the compound Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:3) at doses of 3 mg/kg (diamonds), 1 mg/kg (triangles), 0.5 mg/kg (squares) and 0.3 mg/kg (x symbols), or saline (squares); the dashed line in FIG. 8 indicating baseline PTH level pre-dosing;
  • FIG. 9 is a graph of parathyroid hormone level, as percent of the baseline pre-dose value, as a function of time, in hours, in rats dosed intravenously with saline (x symbols) or with the compounds Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:6, open diamonds), and Ac-carrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:26, open squares) at 1 mg/kg via a 30-minute IV infusion, where plasma PTH levels were assessed prior to dosing, 16 hours and 24 hours after dosing;
  • FIG. 10 is a graph of parathyroid hormone level, as percent of the baseline pre-dose value, as a function of time, in hours, in rats with acute renal insufficiency (1K1C model), where the rats were dosed via IV bolus with the compounds Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:3, squares, * symbols) and Ac-c(Ac-C)arrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:146, triangles, diamonds) at doses of 0.3 mg/kg (squares, triangles) and 0.5 mg/kg (*, diamonds);
  • FIG. 11 is a graph of parathyroid hormone level, as percent of the baseline pre-dose value, as a function of time, in hours, in rats treated via micropore-facilitated transdermal delivery of Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:6, two animals, squares and triangles) or with saline via transdermal delivery (diamonds);
  • FIG. 12 is a graph of parathyroid hormone level, as percent of the baseline pre-dose value, as a function of time, in hours, in rats treated via micropore-facilitated transdermal delivery of Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:3);
  • FIG. 13 is a graph of mean PTH (as percent of baseline) during and following a 6 hour IV infusion of Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:3) in normal Sprague-Dawley rats, where the compound was infused at rates of 1 μg/kg/hr (squares), 3 μg/kg/hr (circles), and 10 μg/kg/hr (triangles);
  • FIG. 14A shows PTH (as a percent of baseline) during and following a 6 hour IV infusion of Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:3) in the 1K1C rat model of acute renal insufficiency, where rats were intravenously infused at dose rates of 30 μg/kg/hr (diamonds) and 100 μg/kg/hr (squares);
  • FIG. 14B is a bar graph showing serum calcium, in mg/dL, for the 1K1C model rats treated as in FIG. 14A.
  • The present subject matter may be understood more readily by reference to the following detailed description of the preferred embodiments and the examples included herein.
  • DETAILED DESCRIPTION I. Definitions
  • Within this application, unless otherwise stated, definitions of the terms and illustration of the techniques of this application may be found in any of several well-known references such as: Sambrook, J., et al., Molecular Cloning: A Laboratory Manual, Cold Spring Harbor Laboratory Press (1989); Goeddel, D., ed., Gene Expression Technology, Methods in Enzymology, 185, Academic Press, San Diego, Calif. (1991); “Guide to Protein Purification” in Deutshcer, M. P., ed., Methods in Enzymology, Academic Press, San Diego, Calif. (1989); Innis, et al., PCR Protocols: A Guide to Methods and Applications, Academic Press, San Diego, Calif. (1990); Freshney, R. I., Culture of Animal Cells: A Manual of Basic Technique, 2nd Ed., Alan Liss, Inc. New York, N.Y. (1987); Murray, E. J., ed., Gene Transfer and Expression Protocols, pp. 109-128, The Humana Press Inc., Clifton, N.J. and Lewin, B., Genes VI, Oxford University Press, New York (1997).
  • As used herein, the singular form “a”, “an”, and “the” include plural references unless indicated otherwise. For example, “a” modulator peptide includes one of more modulator peptides.
  • As used herein a compound has “activity to decrease parathyroid hormone level” or “PTH-lowering activity” when the compound, upon administration to a subject, lowers plasma parathyroid hormone (PTH) relative to the plasma PTH concentration prior to administration of the compound. In one embodiment, the decrease in PTH level is at least 20%, 30%, 40%, 50%, 60%, 70%, 80%, 90% or 95% lower one hour after compound administration that the PTH level prior to administration of the compound.
  • As used herein, “absence of a histamine response” or “lack of a histamine response” intends a dose of a compound that produces a less than 15-fold, 14-fold, 13-fold, 12-fold, 11-fold, 10-fold, 9-fold, 8-fold, 7-fold, 6-fold, 5-fold, 4-fold, or 3-fold increase in histamine, measured in vitro in an assay as described herein, where the fold change is determined based on histamine levels before incubation with the compound and after 15 minutes incubation with compound.
  • As used herein, “amino acid” refers to natural and non-natural amino acids. The twenty naturally occurring amino acids (L-isomers) are designated by the three letter code with the prefix “L-” (except for glycine which is achiral) or by the one letter code in upper-case: alanine (“L-Ala” or “A”), arginine (“L-Arg” or “R”), asparagine (“L-Asn” or “N”), aspartic acid (“L-Asp” or “D”), cysteine (“L-Cys” or “C”), glutamine (“L-Gln” or “Q”), glutamic acid (“L-Glu” or “E”), glycine (“Gly” or “G”), histidine (“L-His” or “H”), isoleucine (“L-Ile” or “I”), leucine (“L-Leu” or “L”), lysine (“L-Lys” or “K”), methionine (“L-Met” or “M”), phenylalanine (“L-Phe” or “F”), proline (“L-Pro” or “P”), serine (“L-Ser” or “S”), threonine (“L-Thr” or “T”), tryptophan (“L-Trp” or “W”), tyrosine (“L-Tyr” or “Y”) and valine (“L-Val” or “V”). L-norleucine and L-norvaline may be represented as (NLeu) and (NVal), respectively. The nineteen naturally occurring amino acids that are chiral have a corresponding D-isomer which is designated by the three letter code with the prefix “D-” or by the lower-case one letter code: alanine (“D-Ala” or “a”), arginine (“D-Arg” or “r”), asparagine (“D-Asn” or “a”), aspartic acid (“D-Asp” or “d”), cysteine (“D-Cys” or “c”), glutamine (“D-Gln” or “q”), glutamic acid (“D-Glu” or “e”), histidine (“D-His” or “h”), isoleucine (“D-Ile” or “i”), leucine (“D-Leu” or “I”), lysine (“D-Lys” or “k”), methionine (“D-Met” or “m”), phenylalanine (“D-Phe” or “f”), proline (“D-Pro” or “p”), serine (“D-Ser” or “5”), threonine (“D-Thr” or “t”), tryptophan (“D-Trp” or “w”), tyrosine (“D-Tyr” or “y”) and valine (“D-Val” or “v”). D-norleucine and D-norvaline may be represented as (dNLeu) and (dNVal), respectively. Although “amino acid residue” is often used in reference to a monomeric subunit of a peptide, polypeptide or protein, and “amino acid” is often used in reference to a free molecule, usage of these terms in the art overlaps and varies. The term “amino acid” and “amino acid residue” are used interchangeably and may refer to a free molecule or a monomeric subunit of a peptide, polypeptide or protein, depending on context.
  • To determine the percent “homology” or percent “identity” of two amino acid sequences, the sequences are aligned for optimal comparison purposes (e.g., gaps can be introduced in the sequence of one polypeptide for optimal alignment with the other polypeptide). The amino acid residues at corresponding amino acid positions are then compared. When a position in one sequence is occupied by the same amino acid residue as the corresponding position in the other sequence, then the molecules are identical at that position. As used herein amino acid or nucleic acid “homology” is equivalent to amino acid or nucleic acid “identity”. Accordingly, the percent sequence identity between the two sequences is a function of the number of identical positions shared by the sequences (i.e., percent sequence identity=numbers of identical positions/total numbers of positions×100). Percent sequence identity between two polypeptide sequences can be determined using the Vector NTI software package (Invitrogen Corporation, 5791 Van Allen Way, Carlsbad, Calif. 92008). A gap opening penalty of 10 and a gap extension penalty of 0.1 are used for determining the percent identity of two polypeptides. All other parameters are set at the default settings.
  • A “cationic amino acid” intends an amino acid residue that has a net positive charge at physiologic pH (7.4), as is the case, for example, in the amino acid residues where the side chain, or “R group”, contains an amine functional group or other functional group that can accept a proton to become positively charged at physiologic pH, such as a guanidine or imidazole moiety. Cationic amino acid residues include arginine, lysine, histidine, 2,3-diaminopropionic acid (Dap), 2,4-diaminobutyric acid (Dab), ornithine, and homoarginine.
  • A “cationic subunit” intends a subunit that has a net positive charge at physiologic pH (7.4).
  • As used herein, “conservative amino acid substitutions” are substitutions which do not result in a significant change in the activity or tertiary structure of a selected polypeptide or protein. Such substitutions typically involve replacing a selected amino acid residue with a different amino acid residue having similar physico-chemical properties. Groupings of amino acids and amino acid residues by physico-chemical properties are known to those of skill in the art. For example, among the naturally-occurring amino acids, families of amino acid residues having similar side chains have been defined in the art, and include basic side chains (e.g., lysine, arginine, histidine), acidic side chains (e.g., aspartic acid, glutamic acid), uncharged polar side chains (e.g., glycine, asparagine, glutamine, serine, threonine, tyrosine, cysteine), nonpolar side chains (e.g., alanine, valine, leucine, isoleucine, proline, phenylalanine, methionine, tryptophan), beta-branched side chains (e.g., threonine, valine, isoleucine) and aromatic side chains (e.g., tyrosine, phenylalanine, tryptophan, histidine).
  • As used herein, “chemical cross-linking” refers to covalent bonding of two or more molecules.
  • A peptide or peptide fragment is “derived from” a parent peptide or polypeptide if it has an amino acid sequence that is identical or homologous to at least a contiguous sequence of five amino acid residues, more preferably eight amino acid residues, of the parent peptide or polypeptide. The compounds described herein may be in the form of pharmaceutically acceptable salts. Pharmaceutically acceptable salts include acid addition salts, such as hydrochloride, hydrobromide, sulfurate, nitrate, phosphorate, acetate, propionate, glycolate, pyruvate, oxalate, malate, malonate, succinate, maleate, fumarate, tartarate, citrate, benzoate, cinnamate, mandelate, methanesulfonate, ethanesulfonate, p-toluene-sulfonate, salicylate and the like, and base addition salts, such as sodium, potassium, calcium, magnesium, lithium, aluminum, zinc, ammonium, ethylenediamine, arginine, piperazine and the like.
  • As used herein, the term “hyperparathyroidism” refers to primary, secondary and tertiary hyperparathyroidism, unless otherwise indicated.
  • The term “intradermal” intends that in the methods of treatment described herein a therapeutically effective amount of a calcimimetic compound is applied to skin to deliver the compound to layers of skin beneath the stratum corneum, and thus achieve a desired therapeutic effect.
  • As used herein, an “isolated” or “purified” polypeptide or biologically active portion thereof is free of some of the cellular material when produced by recombinant DNA techniques, or chemical precursors or other chemicals when chemically synthesized. The language “substantially free of cellular material” includes preparations of polypeptides in which the polypeptide is separated from some of the cellular components of the cells in which it is naturally or recombinantly produced. When the polypeptide or biologically active portion thereof is recombinantly produced, it is also preferably substantially free of culture medium, i.e., culture medium represents less than about 20%, more preferably less than about 10%, and most preferably less than about 5% of the volume of the polypeptide preparation. The language “substantially free of chemical precursors or other chemicals” includes preparations of polypeptides in which the polypeptide is separated from chemical precursors or other chemicals that are involved in the synthesis of the polypeptide. In one embodiment, the language “substantially free of chemical precursors or other chemicals” includes preparations of a polypeptide having less than about 30% (by dry weight) of chemical precursors or other chemicals, preferably less than about 20% chemical precursors or other chemicals, more preferably less than about 15% chemical precursors or other chemicals, still more preferably less than about 10% chemical precursors or other chemicals, and most preferably less than about 5% chemical precursors or other chemicals. In preferred embodiments, isolated polypeptides, or biologically active portions thereof, lack contaminating polypeptides from the same organism from which the domain polypeptide is derived.
  • As used herein, “macromolecule” refers to a molecule, such as a peptide, polypeptide, protein or nucleic acid, that typically has a molecular weight greater than about 900 Daltons.
  • A “non-cationic amino acid” intends an amino acid residue that has no charge or a net negative charge at physiologic pH (7.4), as is the case, for example, in the amino acid residues where the side chain, or “R group”, is neutral (neutral polar and neutral non-polar) and acidic. Non-cationic amino acids include those residues with an R group that is a hydrocarbon alkyl or aromatic moiety (e.g., valine, alanine, leucine, isoleucine, phenylalanine); a neutral, polar R group (asparagine, cysteine, glutamine, serine, threonine, tryptophan, tyrosine); or a neutral, non-polar R group (glycine, methionine, proline, valine, isoleucine). Non-cationic amino acids with an acidic R group include asparatic acid and glutamic acid.
  • A “polymer” refers to a linear chain of two or more identical or non-identical subunits joined by covalent bonds.
  • As used herein, “peptide” and “polypeptide” refer to any polymer made up of a chain of amino acid residues linked by peptide bonds, regardless of its size. Although “protein” is often used in reference to relatively large polypeptides, and “peptide” is often used in reference to small polypeptides, usage of these terms in the art overlaps and varies. Thus, for simplicity, the term “peptide” will be used herein, although in some cases the art may refer to the same polymer as a “polypeptide.” Unless otherwise indicated, the sequence for a peptide is given in the order from the amino terminus to the carboxyl terminus.
  • A “thiol-containing group” or “thiol-containing moiety” as used herein intends a functional group comprising a sulfur-hydrogen bond (—SH), and that is capable of reacting with another thiol under physiologic conditions to form a disulfide bond. A thiol that is capable of forming a disulfide bond with another thiol is referred to herein as a “reactive thiol.” In a preferred embodiment the thiol-containing group is less than 6 atoms away from the backbone of the compound. In a more preferred embodiment, the thiol-containing group has the structure (—SH—CH2—CH2—C(O)—O—)—.
  • As used herein, “small molecule” refers to a molecule other than a macromolecule, such as an organic molecule, and typically has a molecular weight of less than 1000 daltons.
  • As used herein, “subject” refers to a human subject or an animal subject.
  • A “subunit” intends a monomeric unit that is joined to more than one other monomeric unit to form a polymeric compound, where a subunit is the shortest repeating pattern of elements in the polymeric compound. Exemplary subunits are amino acids, which when linked form a polymer compound such as those referred to in the art as a peptide, a polypeptide or a protein.
  • As used herein, a “therapeutically effective amount” is an amount required to produce a desired therapeutic effect. For example, in methods for reducing serum calcium in hypercalcemic subjects, a therapeutically effective amount is the amount required to reduce serum calcium levels by at least 1%, 2%, 3%, 4%, 5%, 6%, 7%, 8%, 9%, 10%, 11%, 12%, 13%, 14%, 15%, 16%, 17%, 18%, 19%, 20% or 25%. Calcium may be measured as total calcium or as ionized calcium. By way of another example, in methods for lowering in vivo PTH, a therapeutically effective amount is the amount required to reduce PTH levels by at least 1%, 2%, 3%, 4%, 5%, 6%, 7%, 8%, 9%, 10%, 11%, 12%, 13%, 14%, 15%, 16%, 17%, 18%, 19%, 20% or 25%.
  • As used herein, the term “transdermal” means that in the methods of treatment described herein a therapeutically effective amount of a calcimimetic agent is applied to skin to deliver the compound to systemic circulation and thus achieve a desired therapeutic effect.
  • Unless otherwise specified, all documents referred to herein are incorporated by reference in their entirety.
  • II. Compounds
  • In one aspect, a compound comprising the sequence of subunits X1-X2-X3-X4-X5-X6-X7 is provided, where X1 is a subunit comprising a thiol group; X5 is a cationic subunit; X6 is a non-cationic subunit; X7 is a cationic a subunit; and at least two of X2, X3 and X4 are independently a cationic subunit. The compounds have activity to decrease parathyroid hormone (PTH) levels and/or decrease calcium levels in a subject's blood. A decrease in parathyroid hormone levels, as will be illustrated below, intends a lowering of plasma or blood PTH concentration in a subject relative to the plasma or blood PTH concentration prior to treatment with the compound. In one embodiment, the compound achieves a reduction in plasma PTH concentration by at least 50% within one hour after dosing, relative to the plasma PTH prior to dosing. The compounds are exemplified by peptides, although a skilled artisan will appreciate that non-peptidic compounds that have the desired activity can be designed based on the structure-activity relationship studies described herein.
  • As used herein parathyroid hormone or PTH is an 84 amino acid peptide produced by the parathyroid gland and its breakdown products. Besides full length PTH (which consists of residues 1-84 and is sometimes referred to as “intact” of “bioactive” PTH) various PTH fragments generated by proteolysis and other routes of metabolism are present in blood. The amino-terminal 1-34 region of the intact PTH molecule is biologically active. This region of the molecule contains the amino acid sequence that enables PTH to bind to the parathyroid hormone receptors in target tissues. The middle and carboxy-terminal 35-84 region of the intact PTH molecule is believed to be biologically inert but possesses immunological reactivity. PTH 7-84 is thought to exert effects that are opposite to those of 1-84 PTH. Various assays have been developed to measure PTH levels including various breakdown products and are reviewed by Souberbielle et. al., Kidney International, 77:93-100 (2010), which is incorporated herein by reference. In one embodiment, a compound having activity to decrease PTH level as defined herein is ascertained using a validated PTH quantification method that detects the intact bioactive form of PTH(1-84), and commercially available kits are known in the art (e.g., see Example 3 herein).
  • In a first study, compounds containing 4 to 7 cationic (e.g., arginine) subunits were generated and tested for their ability to lower PTH as compared with baseline PTH values and saline-treated animals. Specifically, a 1K1C model of acute renal insufficiency was established for use in characterizing the PTH-lowering activity in a renal dysfunction environment. The 1K1C model is described in Example 1A, and the compounds synthesized for testing included (i) Ac-crrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:4), (ii) Ac-crrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:5), (iii) Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:6), (iv) Ac-crrrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:7) and (v) saline control.
  • As described in Example 1B, the compounds identified as SEQ ID NO:4, SEQ ID NO:5, SEQ ID NO:6 and SEQ ID NO:7 were each administered by a 30-minute IV infusion to 1K1C model animals. FIG. 1 shows the reduction in plasma PTH levels as a percent of the pre-dosing (baseline) level. All four compounds dosed at 3 mg/kg produced a significant drop in plasma PTH, but differences in the potency and duration of PTH reduction suggest a relationship between the net positive charge and PTH-lowering activity. For example, the compound Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:6; triangles) with six cationic (arginine) subunits had increased efficacy as well as the duration of action compared to the compounds Ac-crrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:4; diamonds) and Ac-crrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:5; squares), containing four and five cationic (arginine) subunits, respectively. Surprisingly, the compound Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:6; triangles) with six cationic (arginine) subunits had increased duration of action compared to the compound Ac-crrrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:7, open squares) with seven cationic (arginine) residues, suggesting that activity or potency of the compounds does not correlate merely with increasing cationic charge of the compound. That is, the compound Ac-crrrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:7) with seven cationic subunits (arginine residues) produced a similar initial drop in PTH as the compounds with fewer cationic residues, but over the 24 hours following dosing was less efficacious than Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:6) and Ac-crrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:5). These latter two compounds produced a mean PTH reduction of ˜40% and 60% at the 24 hour time point, respectively. Both the extent of PTH reduction and duration of PTH are important criteria for obtaining optimal therapeutic benefit for patients in need of treatment. It should be noted that the compounds in this study were administered at the same mg/kg dose but, due to differences in molecular weight, a different number of moles of each compound was actually dosed. Therefore, Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:6) was significantly more potent than Ac-crrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:4) and Ac-crrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:5) on a per mole basis.
  • Further studies were done to explore the structure-activity relationship of the compounds. The compound Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:6) was modified by sequential replacement of an arginine residue with an alanine residue at each of the subunit positions X2-X7. The compounds were characterized in an in vitro human calcium-sensing receptor (CaSR) assay, described in Example 2, wherein HEK 293 cells that express the human calcium-sensing receptor were used to measure activity of exemplary compounds. Without wishing to be bound by theory, it is thought that the mechanism by which the described compounds lower PTH in vivo is through the activation of the CaSR, which is expressed in the parathyroid gland and controls PTH secretion. Activation of the CaSR leads to an increase in intracellular calcium and inositol-3-phosphate (IP3) and the subsequent accumulation of inositol-phosphate-1 (IP1). Accordingly, in this in vitro assay, the half maximal effective concentration of compound to reduce IP1 generation by 50% was determined (EC50). The same compounds were also tested in vivo to determine their PTH-lowering activity, as described in Example 3. Results are shown in Table 1. The numbers in the column titled “% PTH AUC (1-4 hrs) of saline control” of Table 1 define activity as reduction in Area Under the Curve (AUC) of PTH over 4 hours as a percent of PTH AUC derived from saline-treated control rats. For example, an AUC (compound treated)/AUC (saline control)*100 that is equal to 0 would be indicative of a highly active PTH-lowering compound that completely suppresses PTH (to an undetectable level) for 4 hours after a single IV administration of isoflurane (IF)-anesthetized normal rats. In contrast, a value of AUC (compound treated)/AUC (saline control)*100 that is equal to or greater than 100 would be indicative of an inactive compound.
  • TABLE 1
    In vitro and In vivo
    activity of Exemplary Compounds
    In vivo activity
    in normal rats**
    % PTH
    reduction of 0.5 mg/kg
    baseline at IV bolus
    1 hour post % PTH In
    IV admin. AUC of vitro
    SEQ ID of 0.5 mg/kg saline EC50
    NO. Structure* compound control (uM)
    SEQ ID Ac-crrrrrr-   4   0 0.5 
    NO: 6 NH2
    SEQ ID Ac-carrrrr-   0   0 1.1 
    NO: 8 NH2
    SEQ ID Ac-crarrrr-   0   7 1.0 
    NO: 9 NH2
    SEQ ID Ac-crrarrr-   0   0 1.1 
    NO: 10 NH2
    SEQ ID Ac-crrrarr-   9  45 5.9 
    NO: 11 NH2
    SEQ ID Ac-crrrrar-   3   3 0.45
    NO: 12 NH2
    SEQ ID Ac-crrrrra-   4  28 1.1 
    NO: 13 NH2
    Saline 128 100 ND
    *Bolded fond indicates D-alanine substitutions of cationic amino acids (D-arginine in SEQ ID NO: 6.
    **PTH reduction following 0.5 mg/kg IV administration in isofluorane-anesthetized normal rats-PTH was measured at 1, 2, 3 and 4 hours post administration and cumulative AUC was calculated. PTH data were calculated according to the following formula: AUCcmpd treated/AUCsaline control*100.
  • In Table 1, the compounds Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:6), Ac-carrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:8) and Ac-crrarrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:10) were quite potent, as evidenced by the decrease in percent PTH to below the detection limit or essentially zero as measured in vivo after a single IV administration in normal rats. Substitution of the cationic (arginine) residue at positions 2, 3, 4 or 7 of Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:6) resulted in an approximately two-fold loss in in vitro potency. The substitution at position 5 to produce the compound Ac-crrrarr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:11) produced a 5-10 fold reduction in in vitro potency, although the in vivo percent PTH AUC reduction of 45% could be sufficiently active for clinical therapy. Surprisingly, the substitution of the cationic arginine residue at position 6 with the uncharged (alanine) residue actually improved potency. The data illustrate that cationic and uncharged residues at different positions are not all equal and there are changes in activity as a result of change in the compound structure.
  • To further evaluate the effect of change in activity as a function of change in compound structure, another series of analogs of Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:6) was generated containing double amino acid substitutions, where two cationic (arginine) residues were replaced by uncharged (alanine) residues, and tested for potency. Data are shown in Table 2. It is worth noting that this series of compounds have the same net cationic charge as SEQ ID NO:4 (four cationic residues) yet surprisingly some are very active (SEQ ID NO:26) with very low % PTH AUC of saline control while others are inactive (e.g., SEQ ID NO:14). Unexpectedly, this suggests that position of charges as well as total cationic charge can influence potency of the compounds for reduction of PTH. The data shown in Table 2 is consistent with the data shown in Table 1 suggesting that the cationic residues of SEQ ID NO:6 are essential at positions 5 and 7 but is not required at position 6, for PTH-lowering activity.
  • TABLE 2
    In vivo Activity of Exemplary Compounds
    In vivo activity
    in normal rats**
    % PTH reduction
    of baseline at 0.5 mg/kg
    1 hour post IV IV bolus
    administration % PTH AUC
    SEQ ID Compound of 0.5 mg/kg of saline
    NO. Structure* compound control*
    Saline Saline 128 100
    SEQ ID Ac-crrarra-  86 130
    NO: 14 NH2
    SEQ ID Ac-cararrr-  75 116
    NO: 15 NH2
    SEQ ID Ac-carrarr- 118 105
    NO: 16 NH2
    SEQ ID Ac-crraarr-  39 102
    NO: 17 NH2
    SEQ ID Ac-crararr-  72  87
    NO: 18 NH2
    SEQ ID Ac-carrrra-  29  72
    NO: 19 NH2
    SEQ ID Ac-crarrra-  45  69
    NO: 20 NH2
    SEQ ID Ac-crrraar-  36  50
    NO: 21 NH2
    SEQ ID Ac-caarrrr-  24  48
    NO: 22 NH2
    SEQ ID Ac-crarrar-   0  43
    NO: 23 NH2
    SEQ ID Ac-craarrr-   8   9
    NO: 24 NH2
    SEQ ID Ac-crrarar-   4   6
    NO: 25 NH2
    SEQ ID Ac-carrrar-   0   1
    NO: 26 NH2
    SEQ ID Ac-c(C)arrrar-   2   8
    NO: 27 NH2
    SEQ ID Ac-c(C)rrarar-   0  16
    NO: 28 NH2
    *Bolded font indicates respective D-alanine substitutions of cationic amino acids (D-arginine) in Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO: 6)
    **PTH reduction following 0.5 mg/kg IV administration in isofluorine-anesthetized normal rats-PTH was measured at 1, 2, 3 and 4 hours post administration and cumulative AUC was calculated. PTH data were calculated according to the following formula: AUCcmpd treated/AUCsaline control*100.
  • The data in Table 2 illustrates the structural changes that influence activity. In one embodiment, the compound is Ac-caarrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:22) and in another embodiment, the compound is Ac-craarrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:24).
  • Further structure-activity relationship studies were conducted using the in vitro cell assay in HEK 293 cells that express the human calcium-sensing receptor, as described in Example 4. The ability of the peptides Ac-carrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:26) and Ac-arrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:29) to activate the human CaSR was ascertained by the measuring accumulation of inositol monophosphate (IP1), which is reflective of IP3 production. IP3 production is an important cell signaling second messenger and its production is a direct downstream consequence of CaSR activation. Accumulation of IP1 following IP3 production can be obtained by treating the cells used in the assay with Lithium Chloride (LiCl2) which inhibits the enzyme that converts IP1 to inositol. In the studies described in Example 4 accumulation of IP1 was measured in the presence of the exemplary compounds Ac-carrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:26) and Ac-arrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:29). Results are shown in FIG. 2A.
  • The concentration of IP1 is reported as nM along the Y-axis and compound concentrations of SEQ ID NO:26 or SEQ ID NO:29 are reported as M along the X-axis. Absence of the N-terminal D-cysteine residue from SEQ ID NO:29 dramatically reduced the ability of the compound to activate the CaSR as compared to SEQ ID NO:26. That is, elimination of the N-terminal cysteine residue significantly reduced the potency of the compound, as the peptides Ac-carrrar-NH (SEQ ID NO:26) and Ac-arrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:29) differ only by the presence or absence of the N-terminal D-cysteine.
  • The contribution of the thiol-containing group in the X1 subunit of the compound (e.g., in certain embodiments where the compound is a peptide on the N-terminal residue), was also investigated in an in vivo study. The PTH-lowering activity of the peptides identified as SEQ ID NO:26 (Ac-carrrar-NH2) and as SEQ ID NO:29 (Ac-arrrar-NH2) was evaluated in vivo according to the procedures in Example 4. Plasma PTH levels were assessed prior to dosing and at 1, 2, 3 and 4 hours after dosing. The results are shown in FIG. 2B. As seen, a 0.5 mg/kg dose of the peptide Ac-carrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:26) (squares) decreased PTH blood concentration to a non-detectable level for up to 4 hours after dosing. In contrast, the peptide lacking an N-terminal residue with a thiol-containing group, Ac-arrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:29), diamonds, did not reduce PTH concentration, even at a substantially higher dose (i.e., 9 mg/kg).
  • The structure-activity relationship of the thiol-containing group in the X1 subunit of the compound was further analyzed by preparing compounds with differing X1 subunits. The compounds, shown in Table 3, were tested in vivo in normal rats for activity to reduce PTH.
  • TABLE 3
    In vivo Activity of Exemplary Compounds
    In vivo
    activity in
    normal rats*
    0.5 mg/kg
    IV bolus
    % PTH AUC of
    saline
    SEQ ID NO. Compound Structure control**
    Saline Saline 100
    SEQ ID NO: 6 Ac-crrrrrr-NH 2   3
    SEQ ID NO: 30 Ac-bAla-crrrrrr-NH 2   0
    SEQ ID NO: 31 Mpa-rrrrrr-NH 2   2
    SEQ ID NO: 32 Ac-dHcy-rrrrrr-NH2  21
    SEQ ID NO: 33 Ac-dPen-rrrrrr-NH2   9
    *Bolded font indicates respective substitution of thiol-containing residue (D-cysteine) in Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO: 6).
    **PTH reduction following 0.5 mg/kg IV administration in isoflurane-anesthetized normal rats-PTH was measured at 1, 2, 3 and 4 hours post administration and cumulative AUC was calculated. PTH data were calculated according to the following formula: AUCcmpd treated/AUCsaline control*100.
  • The data in Table 3 illustrates that the thiol-containing X1 subunit can be varied. Compounds with the following in the N-terminal residue were tested—D-cysteine (cys), D-penicillamine (dPen), d-homocysteine (dHcy) and mercaptopropionic acid (Mpa). In addition, a natural or non-natural amino acid, such as beta alanine, can be conjugated to the N-terminal thiol-containing residue. The data illustrates that cationic compounds such as Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:6) containing different thiol-containing groups in the X1 subunit effectively reduce PTH in vivo. Substituting the N-terminal cysteine residue with methionine, which does not contain a thiol group, resulted in a compound with very poor in vivo PTH-lowering activity (data not shown).
  • Based on the studies above, compounds of the contiguous sequence of subunits X1-X2-X3-X4-X5-X6-X7, where X1 is a subunit comprising a thiol-containing group, have activity to decrease parathyroid hormone levels. In one embodiment, the thiol-containing group on the X1 subunit is selected from the group consisting of thiol-containing amino acid residues and organic thiol-containing moieties. In another embodiment, the thiol-containing group is capable of reacting with another thiol group under physiologic pH and temperature. In certain embodiments where the thiol-containing residue is an amino acid residue, the X1 subunit can be any one of cysteine, glutathione, mercapto-propionic acid, n-acetylated cysteine and PEGylated cysteine. In embodiments where the thiol-containing group is on a non-amino acid residue subunit, such an organic small molecule with a thiol-containing group, the X1 subunit can be a thiol-alkyl, or thioacyl moieties such as 3-mercaptopropyl or 3-mercaptopropionyl residues. In one embodiment, the thiol is not homocysteine.
  • Accordingly, and in another embodiment, the compounds described herein have “clinical activity to decrease parathyroid hormone level”, which intends that the compound, upon administration to a subject, lowers plasma parathyroid hormone as measured by the cumulative PTH area under the curve (PTH AUC) over 4 hours post administration compared to PTH AUC of a corresponding vehicle treated control subject. The plasma PTH concentrations are measured using, for example, a commercially available ELISA kit that detects bioactive intact PTH 1-84 (see Example 3 for a specific kit). compound with clinical activity to decrease parathyroid hormone level reduces the PTH AUC by at least 20%, 30%, 40%, 50%, 60%, 70%, 80%, 90%, 95% compared to the PTH AUC of a corresponding vehicle treated control subject.
  • The studies above, and others described below, illustrate further embodiments of the compounds described herein, wherein the X1 subunit in some embodiments can be modified chemically, such as by chemical modification to include an acetyl group, a benzoyl group, a benzyl group, a butyl group, a natural or unnatural amino acid such as acetylated-beta-alanine or is joined by a covalent linkage to another thiol moiety. Peptide therapeutics may be vulnerable to attack by peptidases. Exopeptidases are typically non-specific enzymes which cleave amino acid residues from the amino or carboxy termini of a peptide or protein. Endopeptidases, which cleave within an amino acid sequence, can also be non-specific; however endopeptidases frequently recognize particular amino sequences (recognition sites) and cleave the peptide at or near those sites. Accordingly, modifications to the compound to protect it from proteolytic degradation are contemplated.
  • One method of protecting a peptide from proteolytic degradation involves chemically modifying, or “capping,” the amino and/or carboxy termini of the peptides. As used herein, the terms “chemically modified” or “capped” are used interchangeably to refer to the introduction of a blocking group to a terminus or to both termini of the compound via a covalent modification. Suitable blocking groups serve to cap the termini of the peptides without decreasing the biological activity of the peptides. Any residue positioned at the amino or carboxy termini, or both, of the described compounds, including the thiol-containing subunits can be chemically modified.
  • In a preferred embodiment, the amino terminus of the compound is chemically modified by acetylation, to provide an N-acetyl peptide (which may be represented as “Ac-” in a structure or formula herein). In a preferred embodiment, the carboxy terminus of the described peptides, is chemically modified by amidation to provide a primary carboxamide at the C-terminus (which may be represented as “—NH2” in a peptide sequence, structure or formula herein). In a preferred embodiment, both the amino terminus and carboxy terminus are chemically modified by acetylation and amidation, respectively. However, other capping groups are possible. For example, the amino terminus may be capped by acylation with groups such as an acetyl group, a benzoyl group, or with natural or unnatural amino acids such as beta-alanine capped with an acetyl group, or by alkylation with groups such as a benzyl group or a butyl group, or by sulfonylation to form sulfonamides. Similarly, the carboxy terminus may be esterified, or converted to a secondary amide, and acyl sulfonamide, or the like. In some embodiments, the amino terminus or the carboxy terminus may comprise a site for attachment of a polyethylene glycol (PEG) moiety, i.e., the amino or carboxy termini may be chemically modified by reaction with a suitably functionalized PEG.
  • Protecting peptides from endopeptidases typically involves identification and elimination of an endopeptidase recognition site from a peptide. Protease recognition sites are well known to those of ordinary skill in the art. Thus it is possible to identify a potential endoprotease recognition site and then eliminating that site by altering the amino acid sequence within the recognition site. Residues in the recognition sequence can be moved or removed to destroy the recognition site. Preferably, a conservative substitution is made with one or more of the amino acids which comprise an identified protease recognition site.
  • A. Additional Structure-Activity Relationship Studies
  • Additional structure activity studies were conducted, to further evaluate the effect of properties of each subunit in the compound on its therapeutic activity. These studies are now to be described with reference to Example 5.
  • A series of compounds having an L-amino acid residue substituted for a D-amino acid residue were prepared based on the PTH-lowering scaffold Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:3). The compounds were administered to subjects and plasma PTH levels were assessed prior to dosing and 1, 2, 3 and 4 hours after dosing, as described in Example 5 and the AUC was calculated as the sum of the PTH concentration values at the time points of 1, 2, 3 and 4 hours, normalized by the AUC for the saline control at the same time points, multiplied by 100. The results are shown in Table 4.
  • TABLE 4
    Effect of L-Amino Acid
    Substitution on Potency
    In vivo activity
    in normal rats
    0.5 mg/kg
    IV bolus
    % PTH AUC* of
    Compound Name Structure saline control
    SEQ ID NO: 3 Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH 2   8
    SEQ ID NO: 34 Ac-C(C)arrrar-NH 2  17
    SEQ ID NO: 35 Ac-c(C)Arrrar-NH2  68
    SEQ ID NO: 36 Ac-c(C)aRrrar-NH2  87
    SEQ ID NO: 37 Ac-c(C)arRrar-NH2 182
    SEQ ID NO: 38 Ac-c(C)arrRar-NH2 130
    SEQ ID NO: 39 Ac-c(C)arrrAr-NH2 129
    SEQ ID NO: 40 Ac-c(C)arrraR-NH2 142
    Saline 100
    *PTH reduction following 0.5 mg/kg IV administration in isoflurane-anesthetized normal rats-PTH was measured at 1, 2, 3 and 4 hours post administration and cumulative AUC was calculated. PTH data were calculated according to the following formula: AUCcmpd treated/AUCsaline control*100
  • The exemplary compounds shown in Table 4 were chemically modified at both the N-terminus and the C-terminus, as indicated by the Ac and NH2 designations. The sequence of seven subunits carrrar (SEQ ID NO:3), wherein all subunits were D-amino acid residues, was modified by replacing one subunit at a time with an L-amino acid. The X1 subunit was a D-Cys residue (or L-Cys residue in SEQ ID NO:34) conjugated via a disulfide linkage to an L-Cys residue, as indicated by the parenthetical designation (C). The PTH-lowering in vivo data in Table 4 shows that chirality of Arg and Ala affect activity of the compounds. In one embodiment, a compound of the sequence X1-X2-X3-X4-X5-X6-X7 is contemplated, where at least the subunits identified as X4 and X7 are D-amino acid residue subunits. In another embodiment, the subunits identified as X4, X5, X6 and X7 are D-amino acid residue subunits. In a preferred embodiment, the subunits identified as X3, X4, X5, X6 and X7 are D-amino acid residue subunits. In most preferred embodiments, the subunits identified as X2, X3, X4, X5, X6 and X7 are D-amino acid residue subunits, and all of the subunits X1, X2, X3, X4, X5, X6 and X7 are D-amino acid residue subunits.
  • In other studies, it also was found that substitution of a peptide having all L-amino acids with all D-amino acids did not reduce the in vitro activity of the peptides tested; in fact, peptides composed entirely of D-amino acids appeared to enhance the potency for activation of the CaSR. It was also shown that some of the cationic (arginine) residues, at specific positions relative to the cysteine residue, could be substituted with uncharged (alanine) residues with minimal effect on the activity toward the CaSR.
  • To further characterize the relationship between structure and activity against the CaSR, a variety of cationic peptides with different numbers (4 to 8) of arginine residues (all of which contained an N-terminal cysteine) were tested using the HEK-293 in vitro cell assay. A direct correlation was found between the number of cationic subunits and the potency of the compound, where potency is evidenced by ability to activate the CaSR. Reducing the number of cationic (e.g., arginine) subunits from 5 to 4 resulted in the largest shift in potency (>10-fold) suggesting that there may be an activity inflection point between compounds having these net charges, that a cationic subunit at subunit X5 is preferred for activity. Accordingly, the compounds of the structure X1-X2-X3-X4-X5-X6-X7 are contemplated, wherein X5 is a cationic subunit. In certain embodiments the X1 is a subunit comprises a thiol group that is capable of reacting with another thiol group under physiologic conditions (a “reactive thiol”, intending a thiol that reacts with another thiol (e.g., cysteine with cysteine) under physiologic conditions of pH 7.4 and body temperature).
  • Unexpectedly, Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:6) with six cationic residues, when evaluated in vivo, exhibited greater and more prolonged activity than Ac-crrrrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:41), which has eight cationic residues. This is in contrast to the observation that SEQ ID NO:41 was more potent at activating the CaSR in this in vitro cell assay. Without wishing to be bound by theory, it is thought that the superior performance of Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:6) in vivo may stem from better pharmacokinetic properties of Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:6), because Ac-crrrrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:6441 is expected to be taken up into cells by virtue of its cell-penetrating characteristic, and thus removed from proximity to the active portion of the CaSR.
  • To further explore the structure-activity relationship of Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:6), some of the cationic (arginine) residues were replaced with uncharged (alanine) residues. It was found that replacing the cationic (arginine) residues at subunit positions X2 and X4 resulted in a compound (SEQ ID NO:15) that had significantly reduced potency in vitro in activating the CaSR. By contrast, replacing the cationic (arginine) residues at subunit positions X2 and X6 resulted in a compound (SEQ ID NO:26) that retained much of the potency seen with Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:6). These results suggest that the position of charged residues in the compound contributes to potency and, in some embodiments, may outweigh the contribution of total positive charge of the peptide. It also appears that cationic (arginine) residues at certain positions, such as subunit position X5, contribute disproportionately to potency.
  • It was found that the presence of an N-terminal cysteine markedly enhances the potency of the peptides for activating the CaSR. The CaSR is a 7-transmembrane G-protein-coupled receptor with a large extracellular domain that functions as a homodimeric receptor. There are 18 cysteine residues in the extracellular domain, some of which have been shown by polymorphism or mutational analysis to be important for receptor activity. Of particular note are cysteines 129 and 131 of the Loop 2 region of the extracellular domain. Cysteines 129 and 131 are thought to form an intermolecular disulfide bridge between the two monomers of the receptor complex, which is in a closed or inhibited configuration. Mutation of cysteine 129 activates the CaSR, as do a number of other mutations including a full deletion of the Loop2 region. The enhanced potency provided by the N-terminal cysteine residue in the described compounds could result from a specific interaction with one or more of the cysteine residues in the extracellular domain of the CaSR.
  • To further evaluate the effect of chirality of amino acid substitutions on in vitro CaSR activity, a series of analogs of Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:6) were generated containing L-amino acid or achiral amino acid (glycine) substitutions at various positions and tested for potency against the CaSR. Tested analogs included Ac-cGrrrGr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:42), (ii) Ac-cArrrAr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:43), and (iii) Ac-CaRrRaR-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:44). All of the foregoing analogs had significantly lower potency than Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:6), ranging from a 10-fold difference for SEQ ID NO:44 (the most potent of the three analogs) and a more than 2000-fold difference for SEQ ID NO:43 (the least potent of the three analogs). Ac-carrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:26), in which cationic D-amino acid residues (D-arginine residues) at positions 2 and 6 of SEQ ID NO:6 were replaced by uncharged D-amino acid residues (D-arginine residues), the change in activity was much less (˜3 fold difference). Thus, surprisingly, it was found that interrupting the all D-amino acid residue of Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:6) with two or more L-amino acid residues resulted in a significant reduction in potency. Also surprising was that potency was decreased more than 80-fold when the interrupting residue was an uncharged achiral amino acid residue (glycine residue) compared to when it was an uncharged L-amino acid residue (L-alanine residue).
  • Also surprising was that replacing the two uncharged D-amino acid residues (D-alanine residues) of Ac-carrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:26) with their L-counterparts (SEQ ID NO:43), resulted in a greater than 600-fold decrease in potency, while replacing them with an uncharged achiral amino acid residue (glycine residue) (SEQ ID NO:42) resulted in less than an 8-fold reduction in potency; and that replacing three cationic D-amino acid residues (D-arginine residues) of Ac-carrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:26) with their L-counterparts (SEQ ID NO:44), resulted in less than a 4-fold difference in potency.
  • The activity of a variety of peptides and conjugates was tested against the human CaSR. These studies were conducted by measuring IP1 production in HEK293 cells that express the human CaSR. The EC50 values are shown in Table 5. Each peptide was tested in eight different concentrations, in duplicates, to establish a dose response curve. Curve fitting was performed using GraphPad Prism. In Table 5, and throughout the specification, residues provided in capital letters are L-amino acids, while lower case letters indicate D-amino acids. “Ac” indicates an acetyl capping group, “NH2” indicates an amide capping group, “Ac-bAla” is an acetylated beta-alanine, “GSH” indicates reduced glutathione, “GS” indicates oxidized glutathione, “PEG” refers to polyethylene glycol, “PEG2” and “PEG5” refer to polyethylene glycol moieties of 2 kDa and 5 kDa, respectively, and “Mpa” refers to mercaptopropionic acid. A group bracketed by parentheses indicates that group or moiety is attached to the side-chain of the preceding subunit or amino acid residue.
  • TABLE 5
    EC50 values for cationic peptides in CaSR in vitro assay
    Compound Name Structure EC50 (μM)
    (SEQ ID NO: 45) (SEQ ID NO: 47)
    Figure US20200399309A1-20201224-C00001
    21
    (SEQ ID NO: 46) (SEQ ID NO: 47)
    Figure US20200399309A1-20201224-C00002
    21
    (SEQ ID NO: 47) Ac-CYGRKKRRQRRR-NH2 4.5
    (SEQ ID NO: 48) Ac-YGRKKRRQRRR-NH2 16
    (SEQ ID NO: 41) Ac-crrrrrrrr-NH2 0.3
    (SEQ ID NO: 6) Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 0.5
    (SEQ ID NO: 15) Ac-cararrr-NH2 13
    (SEQ ID NO: 26) Ac-carrrar-NH2 1.6
    (SEQ ID NO: 4) Ac-crrrr-NH2 16
    (SEQ ID NO: 5) Ac-crrrrr-NH2 2.5
    (SEQ ID NO: 7) Ac-crrrrrrr-NH2 0.6
    (SEQ ID NO: 49) Ac-caraarrr-NH2 1000
    (SEQ ID NO: 8) Ac-carrrrr-NH2 1.1
    (SEQ ID NO: 9) Ac-crarrrr-NH2 1
    (SEQ ID NO: 10) Ac-crrarrr-NH2 1.1
    (SEQ ID NO: 50) Ac-cygrkkrrqrrr-NH2 2
    (SEQ ID NO: 51)
    Figure US20200399309A1-20201224-C00003
    0.44
    (SEQ ID NO: 3) Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH2 10
    (SEQ ID NO: 52)
    Figure US20200399309A1-20201224-C00004
    0.7
    (SEQ ID NO: 30) Ac-bAla-crrrrrr-NH2 1
    (SEQ ID NO: 53) Ac-c(GS)rrrrrr-NH2 7.8
    (SEQ ID NO: 54) GS-crrrrrr
    (SEQ ID NO: 55) Ac-c(Ac-C)arrrar-NH2 21
    (SEQ ID NO: 56) Ac-c(Mpa)arrrar-NH2 21
    (SEQ ID NO: 57) Ac-c(PEG2-C)arrrar-NH2 2.3
    (SEQ ID NO: 58) Ac-c(PEG5-C)rrrrrr-NH2 0.58
    (SEQ ID NO: 59) Ac-c(PEG2-C)rrrrrr-NH2 0.02
    (SEQ ID NO: 34) Ac-C(C)arrrar-NH2 2.5
    (SEQ ID NO: 60) c(C)arrrar-NH2 3.1
    (SEQ ID NO: 61) Ac-bAla-c(C)arrrar-NH2 2.6
    (SEQ ID NO: 62) bAla-c(C)arrrar
    (SEQ ID NO: 42) Ac-cGrrrGr-NH2 12
    (SEQ ID NO: 63) Ac-cGrrrGr
    (SEQ ID NO: 64) Ac-cArrrAr
    (SEQ ID NO: 43) Ac-cArrrAr-NH2 >1000
    (SEQ ID NO: 44) Ac-CaRrRaR-NH2 5.6
    (SEQ ID NO: 65) Ac-cvrrrvr-NH2 35
    (SEQ ID NO: 66) Ac-cvrrrvr
    (SEQ ID NO: 67) Ac-Crrrrrr-NH2 6.2
    (SEQ ID NO: 68) Ac-carrrer-NH2 62
    (SEQ ID NO: 69) Ac-cerrrar-NH2 31
    (SEQ ID NO: 72) Ac-cakrrar-NH2 35
    (SEQ ID NO: 73) Ac-carkrar-NH2 31
    (SEQ ID NO: 74) Ac-carrrar-OH 31
    (SEQ ID NO: 11) Ac-crrrarr-NH2 5.9
    (SEQ ID NO: 12) Ac-crrrrar-NH2 0.45
    (SEQ ID NO: 13) Ac-crrrrra-NH2 1.1
    (SEQ ID NO: 75) Ac-CARRRAR-NH2 58
    (SEQ ID NO: 76) Ac-caarrrrrr-NH2 4.5
    (SEQ ID NO: 77) Ac-caaarrrrrr-NH2 4.6
    (SEQ ID NO: 78) Ac-carararar-NH2 5.3
    (SEQ ID NO: 29) Ac-arrrar-NH2 >1000
    (SEQ ID NO: 79) Ac-carrrarar-NH2 13
    (SEQ ID NO: 80) crrrrrr-NH2 1.1
    (SEQ ID NO: 32) Ac-dHcy rrrrrr-NH2 2
    (SEQ ID NO: 81) Ac-c(Benzoyl)rrrrrr-NH2 3.6
    (SEQ ID NO: 82) Ac-c(acetyl)rrrrrr-NH2 4.1
  • In another study of the structure activity relationship, the contribution of non-cationic amino acids to the potency of the peptides was evaluated by preparing a series of peptides with various D-amino acid residues or glycine (Table 6) or with sterically-hindered non-natural amino acids (Table 7), substituted at various positions in the peptide Ac-carrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:26) and in the peptide Ac-crrarar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:153). The peptides were administered as an IV bolus to normal Sprague Dawley rats at a dose of 0.5 mg/kg. An intravenous (IV) bolus of saline was used as a control. Plasma PTH levels were assessed prior to dosing and 1, 2, 3 and 4 hours after dosing. The results are shown in the tables below, and indicate that: 1) a small amino acid such as alanine, glycine or serine is preferred at position 6 in the Ac-carrrar-NH2 peptide (SEQ ID NO:26), and 2) the alanine in position 2 in Ac-carrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:26) is much more permissive to substitutions and can be substituted with hydrophobic (e.g. D-Val, D-Leu), aromatic (e.g. D-Phe), or polar (e.g. D-Ser, D-Gln) natural amino acids as well as non-natural bulky hydrophobic amino acids (e.g. dNle, dNva) but not acidic ones, and that 3) the alanine residue in position 4 of the Ac-crrarar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:25) peptide is also very permissive to substitutions and can accommodate most types of natural amino acids (as well as non-natural bulky hydrophobic amino acids (e.g. dNle, dNva) but is not permissive to amino acids that affect secondary conformation, namely glycine or proline or amino acids with acidic side chain.
  • TABLE 6
    Activity of Exemplary Peptide Compounds
    In vivo activity
    in normal rats**
    0.5 mg/kg IV
    bolus
    Compound % PTH AUC of
    SEQ ID NO. Structure* saline control
    Saline Saline 100
    SEQ ID NO: 83 Ac-carrrfr-NH2 177
    SEQ ID NO: 84 Ac-carrrir-NH2 161
    SEQ ID NO: 85 Ac-carrrlr-NH2 140
    SEQ ID NO: 68 Ac-carrrer-NH2  81
    SEQ ID NO: 87 Ac-carrrvr-NH2  79
    SEQ ID NO: 88 Ac-carrrpr-NH2  76
    SEQ ID NO: 89 Ac-carrrhr-NH2  48
    SEQ ID NO: 90 Ac-carrrqr-NH2  41
    SEQ ID NO: 91 Ac-carrrtr-NH2  18
    SEQ ID NO: 92 Ac-carrrsr-NH2   6
    SEQ ID NO: 93 Ac-carrrGr-NH2   5
    SEQ ID NO: 94 Ac-cerrrar-NH2 103
    SEQ ID NO: 95 Ac-cGrrrar-NH2  45
    SEQ ID NO: 96 Ac-cirrrar-NH2  33
    SEQ ID NO: 97 Ac-cprrrar-NH2  30
    SEQ ID NO: 98 Ac-clrrrar-NH2  26
    SEQ ID NO: 99 Ac-cqrrrar-NH2  24
    SEQ ID NO: 100 Ac-ctrrrar-NH2  23
    SEQ ID NO: 101 Ac-cvrrrar-NH2  19
    SEQ ID NO: 102 Ac-csrrrar-NH2  13
    SEQ ID NO: 103 Ac-chrrrar-NH2   1
    SEQ ID NO: 104 Ac-cfrrrar-NH2   0
    SEQ ID NO: 105 Ac-crrGrar-NH2  69
    SEQ ID NO: 106 Ac-crrprar-NH2  68
    SEQ ID NO: 107 Ac-crrerar-NH2  56
    SEQ ID NO: 108 Ac-crrtrar-NH2  13
    SEQ ID NO: 109 Ac-crrhrar-NH2   9
    SEQ ID NO: 110 Ac-crrfrar-NH2   6
    SEQ ID NO: 111 Ac-crrsrar-NH2   4
    SEQ ID NO: 112 Ac-crrqrar-NH2   4
    SEQ ID NO: 113 Ac-crrvrar-NH2   3
    SEQ ID NO: 114 Ac-crrlrar-NH2   1
    SEQ ID NO: 115 Ac-crrirar-NH2   0
    *Bolded font indicates respective substitution of alanine residues in Ac-carrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO: 6) or Ac-crrarar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO: 25).
    **PTH reduction following 0.5 mg/kg IV administration in isoflurane-anesthetized normal rats-PTH was measured at 1, 2, 3 and 4 hours post administration and cumulative AUC was calculated. PTH data were calculated according to the following formula: AUCcmpd treated/AUCsaline control*100.
  • TABLE 7
    Activity of Exemplary Peptide Compounds
    In vivo
    activity
    in normal
    rats*
    0.5 mg/kg
    IV bolus
    % PTH AUC
    of saline
    SEQ ID NO. Compound Structure* control**
    Saline Saline 100
    SEQ ID NO: 116 Ac-crr-Sar-rar-NH2 141
    SEQ ID NO: 117 Ac-carrr-Sar-r-NH2 111
    SEQ ID NO: 118 Ac-c-Nma-rrr-Nma-r-NH2 105
    SEQ ID NO: 119 Ac-crrar-Nma-r-NH2 101
    SEQ ID NO: 120 Ac-c-Aib-rrr-Aib-r-NH2  94
    SEQ ID NO: 121 Ac-crr-Nma-rar-NH2  86
    SEQ ID NO: 122 Ac-carrr-Nma-r-NH2  74
    SEQ ID NO: 123 Ac-c-Aib-rrrar-NH2  70
    SEQ ID NO: 124 Ac-carrr-Aib-r-NH2  68
    SEQ ID NO: 125 Ac-c-Sar-rrr-Sar-r-NH2  65
    SEQ ID NO: 126 Ac-crrar-Sar-r-NH2  62
    SEQ ID NO: 127 Ac-c-Nma-rrrar-NH2  56
    SEQ ID NO: 128 Ac-c-Sar-rrrar-NH2  50
    SEQ ID NO: 129 Ac-carrr-Nle-r-NH2  64
    SEQ ID NO: 130 Ac-c-dNle-rrr-dNle-r-NH2  54
    SEQ ID NO: 131 Ac-carrr-dNva-r-NH2  54
    SEQ ID NO: 132 Ac-c-dNva-rrr-dNva-r-NH2  27
    SEQ ID NO: 133 Ac-crrar-dNle-r-NH2  26
    SEQ ID NO: 134 Ac-c-dNle-rrrar-NH2  10
    SEQ ID NO: 135 Ac-crrar-dNva-r-NH2   8
    SEQ ID NO: 136 Ac-c-dNva-rrrar-NH2   7
    SEQ ID NO: 137 Ac-crr-dNva-rar-NH2   3
    SEQ ID NO: 138 Ac-crr-dNle-rar-NH2   3
    *Bolded font indicates respective substitution of alanine residues in Ac-carrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO: 26) or Ac-crrarar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO: 25). Sar = the non-natural amino acid Sarcosine; Nma = N-methyl alanine; AiB = amino isobutyric acid; dNva = D-Norvaline; dNle = D-Norleucine
    **PTH reduction following 0.5 mg/kg IV administration in isoflurane-anesthetized normal rats-PTH was measured at 1, 2, 3 and 4 hours post administration and cumulative AUC was calculated. PTH data were calculated according to the following formula: AUCcmpd treated/AUCsaline control*100.
  • TABLE 8
    Activity of Exemplary Peptide Compounds
    In vivo activity in
    normal rats**
    0.5 mg/kg IV
    bolus % PTH AUC
    SEQ ID NO. Compound Structure* of saline control
    Saline Saline
    100
    SEQ ID NO: 97 Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH 2 8
    SEQ ID NO: 101 Ac-c(GS)rrrrrr-NH2 12
    SEQ ID NO: 139 Ac-c(dHcy)arrrar-NH2 32
    SEQ ID NO: 140 Ac-c(Mpa)arrrar-NH 2 25
    SEQ ID NO: 141 Ac-c(Ac C)arrrar-NH2 38
    SEQ ID NO: 142 Ac-c(c)arrrar-NH 2 0
    SEQ ID NO: 143*** Ac-c(C-PEG20)rrrrrr-NH 2 25
    SEQ ID NO: 144**** Ac-c(C-PEG40)rrrrrr-NH 2 15
    SEQ ID NO: 145
    Figure US20200399309A1-20201224-C00005
    40
    SEQ ID NO: 145 SEQ ID NO: 26
    Figure US20200399309A1-20201224-C00006
    42
    SEQ ID NO: 25 SEQ ID NO: 25
    Figure US20200399309A1-20201224-C00007
    2
    SEQ ID NO: 26 SEQ ID NO: 26
    Figure US20200399309A1-20201224-C00008
    1
    *Bolded font showing in parenthesis indicates respective thiol-containing conjugating groups. GS = oxidized glutathione; dHcy = D-homocysteine; Mpa = Mercaptopropionic acid; PEG = polyethylene glycol.
    **PTH reduction following 0.5 mg/kg IV administration in isoflurane-anesthetized normal rats - PTH was measured at 1, 2, 3 and 4 hours post administration and cumulative AUC was calculated. PTH data were calculated according to the following formula: AUCcmpd treated/AUCsaline control*100.
    ***Compound was dosed at 10 mg/kg (~ equivalent molarity to a 0.5 mg/kg non-PEGylated peptide)
    ****Compound was dosed at 20 mg/kg (~ equivalent molarity to a 0.5 mg/kg non-PEGylated peptide)
  • B. Histamine Response and Structure-Activity Relationship Studies
  • Poly-cationic compounds have been reported in the literature to trigger the release of the active biogenic amine histamine. See Church et al., J. Immunol., 128(5):2116-2121 (1982); Lagunoff et al., Ann. Rev. Pharmacol. Toxicol., 23:331-51 (1983). It is thought that histamine release is a result of mast cell and basophil activation occurring in a Gai dependent manner. See Aridor et al., J. Cell Biol., 111(3):909-17 (1990). Reducing or eliminating this physiological reaction is desirable, inter alia, for improving the therapeutic margin of cationic peptide calcimimetics for the treatment of SHPT.
  • Studies were conducted to evaluate the histamine release induced upon in vivo administration of the compounds described herein. In a first study, described in Example 6, dosing by IV bolus or infusion into normal Sprague Dawley rats was used to evaluate histamine release associated with various compounds. To evaluate the effect of net positive charge on the histamine release associated with a compound, peptides containing 4 to 7 cationic (arginine) residues were generated and tested for their ability to trigger histamine release in vivo, according to the procedure described in Example 6. The tested peptides included (i) Ac-crrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:4), (ii) Ac-crrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:5), (iii) Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:6) and (iv) Ac-crrrrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:41).
  • As shown in FIG. 3, when an equivalent number of moles of each peptide was administered by IV bolus to normal rats, SEQ ID NO:41 (8 arginine residues) displayed the largest induction of histamine. Other compounds with fewer Arg residues, including SEQ ID NO:6 (6 arginine residues), SEQ ID NO:5 (5 arginine residues), and SEQ ID NO:4 (4 arginine residues), also produced a spike in histamine level, but to a lesser extent compared to SEQ ID NO:41. SEQ ID NO:6, SEQ ID NO:5 and SEQ ID NO:4 generated milder responses in their histamine release activity (˜2-3 fold above baseline). SEQ ID NO:5 and SEQ ID NO:4 were, however, less potent than SEQ ID NO:6 with respect to lowering plasma PTH.
  • Because the PTH-reducing activity of Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:6) was accompanied by lack of a histamine response, additional evaluations were conducted based on Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:6) in order to evaluate whether it was possible to still further decrease histamine response without sacrificing PTH-lowering activity. As will be shown in the data below, substitution of cationic (arginine) residues in Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:6) with non-cationic (alanine) residues was performed to produce a series of analogs with an overall reduced net charge and reduced charge density. Of these analogs, both Ac-cararrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:15) and Ac-carrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:26) were associated with lack of a histamine response when administered to rats by IV bolus. Importantly, these two peptides retained their potent calcimimetic properties and were able to reduced PTH secretion in both normal rats and rats with renal dysfunction.
  • The compound Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 identified as SEQ ID NO:6 (2.1 μmole/kg=2.3 mg/kg) triggered an observable histamine response of about 2-3 fold over baseline compared to 6-9 fold with SEQ ID NO:41 when dosed by IV bolus (given over less than 1 minute) in normal rats. The histamine release triggered by Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:6) peaked at 5 minutes after dosing and returned to baseline levels 15 minutes later (FIG. 3). Further reduction in the number of charged subunits to 5 and 4 arginine residues per peptide (SEQ ID NO:5 and SEQ ID NO:4, respectively) further reduced the histamine response as compared with the longer oligo-arginine peptides; however, a 2-3 fold increase in histamine over baseline was still observed 5 minutes after IV bolus dosing (FIG. 3). These results suggest a relationship between the net charge of the peptide and the associated release of histamine. It is also noted that arginine-rich peptides with fewer than 7 arginines are quite limited in their ability to enter cells, suggesting that cell penetration is not required to trigger histamine release.
  • The histamine release associated with the PTH-lowering compounds Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:6) and Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:3) was evaluated in vivo. The compound Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:3) has the following structure:
  • Figure US20200399309A1-20201224-C00009
  • This conjugate structure is denoted herein as Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:273 where the L-Cys residue linked to the thiol-containing residue in the X1 subunit of the compound (here, a D-Cys residue) via a Cys-Cys disulfide bond, is placed in parenthesis in the formula. This notation is used throughout to designate that the parenthetical moiety is linked to a second thiol-containing group. Relative to Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:6) the compound Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO: 3) has two cationic (arginine) residues substituted with uncharged (alanine) residues at subunit positions X2 and X6. In addition, the D-Cys residue in the X1 position is conjugated to an L-Cys residue.
  • These two compounds were administered to isoflurane-anesthetized rats (Sprague Dawley) at 3 mg/kg by intravenous (IV) bolus (given over less than 1 minute). Blood was drawn prior to dosing and a 5, 15 and 30 minutes after dosing. Histamine concentration was measured, and the fold change in blood histamine concentration relative to the pre-dose blood histamine concentration is shown in FIG. 4. The compound Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:6, open bars) induced a histamine response, observed at the data point 5 minutes post-dosing where a 7-fold increase in histamine level was observed. The compound Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:3, cross hatched bars) induced no apparent histamine response, as seen by the data points at 5, 10 and 15 minutes post dosing where the histamine level was not increased relative to the pre-dose (time zero) histamine level.
  • To further evaluate the relationship between compound structure and histamine release, a series of compounds was prepared and assessed for their ability to trigger induction of histamine in an in vitro assay using rat peritoneal mast cells. In this assay, compounds are incubated at 10 μM for 15 minutes at 37° C. with cells isolated from peritoneal lavage of SD rats. Following incubation, cell medium is collected and histamine is determined. The data is shown in Table 9.
  • TABLE 9
    In vitro Histamine Induction in Rat Peritoneal Mast Cells of
    Exemplary Peptide Compounds
    *Histamine in
    vitro Fold
    change of
    non-treated
    SEQ ID NO. Compound Sequence at 10 uM*
    Saline Saline 1.0
    SEQ ID NO: 6 Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 11.5
    SEQ ID NO: 8 Ac-carrrrr-NH2 6.6
    SEQ ID NO: 9 Ac-crarrrr-NH2 6.8
    SEQ ID NO: 10 Ac-crrarrr-NH2 5.3
    SEQ ID NO: 11 Ac-crrrarr-NH2 5.0
    SEQ ID NO: 12 Ac-crrrrar-NH2 5.0
    SEQ ID NO: 13 Ac-crrrrra-NH2 4.1
    SEQ ID NO: 15 Ac-cararrr-NH2 2.5
    SEQ ID NO: 22 Ac-caarrrr-NH2 1.2
    SEQ ID NO: 17 Ac-crraarr-NH2 1.3
    SEQ ID NO: 146 Ac-crrrraa-NH2 1.9
    SEQ ID NO: 26 Ac-carrrar-NH2 1.4
    SEQ ID NO: 3 Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH2 0.6
    SEQ ID NO: 16 Ac-carrarr-NH2 1.4
    SEQ ID NO: 19 Ac-carrrra-NH2 1.3
    SEQ ID NO: 23 Ac-crarrar-NH2 1.5
    SEQ ID NO: 18 Ac-crararr-NH2 1.4
    SEQ ID NO: 20 Ac-crarrra-NH2 1.1
    SEQ ID NO: 25 Ac-crrarar-NH2 1.2
    SEQ ID NO: 14 Ac-crrarra-NH2 1.6
    SEQ ID NO: 130 Ac-c-dNle-rrr-dNle-r-NH2 9.2
    SEQ ID NO: 132 Ac-c-dNva-rrr-dNva-r-NH2 4.1
    SEQ ID NO: 28 Ac-c(C)rrarar-NH2 0.7
    SEQ ID NO: 24 Ac-craarrr-NH2 1.0
    SEQ ID NO: 21 Ac-crrraar-NH2 1.0
    SEQ ID NO: 134 Ac-c-dNle-rrrar-NH2 2.2
    SEQ ID NO: 129 Ac-carrr-dNle-r-NH2 2.6
    SEQ ID NO: 136 Ac-c-dNva-rrrar-NH2 2.1
    SEQ ID NO: 131 Ac-carrr-dNva-r-NH2 1.8
    SEQ ID NO: 133 Ac-crrar-dNle-r-NH2 4.3
    SEQ ID NO: 135 Ac-crrar-dNva-r-NH2 1.1
    SEQ ID NO: 95 Ac-cGrrrar-NH2 1.5
    SEQ ID NO: 99 Ac-cqrrrar-NH2 1.9
    SEQ ID NO: 103 Ac-chrrrar-NH2 1.6
    SEQ ID NO: 96 Ac-cirrrar-NH2 3.0
    SEQ ID NO: 98 Ac-clrrrar-NH2 2.2
    SEQ ID NO: 97 Ac-cprrrar-NH2 0.8
    SEQ ID NO: 102 Ac-csrrrar-NH2 0.9
    SEQ ID NO: 100 Ac-ctrrrar-NH2 1.1
    SEQ ID NO: 101 Ac-cvrrrar-NH2 1.5
    SEQ ID NO: 93 Ac-carrrGr-NH2 0.9
    SEQ ID NO: 90 Ac-carrrqr-NH2 0.9
    SEQ ID NO: 89 Ac-carrrhr-NH2 2.0
    SEQ ID NO: 84 Ac-carrrir-NH2 1.8
    SEQ ID NO: 85 Ac-carrrlr-NH2 2.5
    SEQ ID NO: 88 Ac-carrrpr-NH2 1.0
    SEQ ID NO: 92 Ac-carrrsr-NH2 1.2
    SEQ ID NO: 91 Ac-carrrtr-NH2 1.7
    SEQ ID NO: 87 Ac-carrrvr-NH2 1.2
    SEQ ID NO: 147 Ac-cakkkak-NH2 1.1
    SEQ ID NO: 72 Ac-cakrrar-NH2 1.1
    SEQ ID NO: 73 Ac-carkrar-NH2 1.4
    SEQ ID NO: 105 Ac-crrGrar-NH2 1.8
    SEQ ID NO: 112 Ac-crrqrar-NH2 1.2
    SEQ ID NO: 109 Ac-crrhrar-NH2 2.3
    SEQ ID NO: 115 Ac-crrirar-NH2 3.4
    SEQ ID NO: 114 Ac-crrlrar-NH2 4.5
    SEQ ID NO: 106 Ac-crrprar-NH2 1.1
    SEQ ID NO: 111 Ac-crrsrar-NH2 2.0
    SEQ ID NO: 108 Ac-crrtrar-NH2 1.2
    SEQ ID NO: 113 Ac-crrvrar-NH2 1.9
    SEQ ID NO: 104 Ac-cfrrrar-NH2 6.8
    SEQ ID NO: 83 Ac-carrrfr-NH2 4.0
    SEQ ID NO: 68 Ac-carrrer-NH2 1.3
    SEQ ID NO: 110 Ac-crrfrar-NH2 6.2
    SEQ ID NO: 107 Ac-crrerar-NH2 0.6
    SEQ ID NO: 86 Ac-carrkar-NH2 1.0
    SEQ ID NO: 70 Ac-carrrak-NH2 0.9
    SEQ ID NO: 148 Ac-cararar-NH2 0.6
    SEQ ID NO: 25
    Figure US20200399309A1-20201224-C00010
    9.3
    SEQ ID NO: 149 Ac-crrarGr-NH2 1.6
    SEQ ID NO: 150 Ac-crrarqr-NH2 1.6
    SEQ ID NO: 151 Ac-crrarhr-NH2 2.5
    SEQ ID NO: 152 Ac-crrarir-NH2 4.1
    SEQ ID NO: 153 Ac-ca(DAP)rrar-NH2 1.6
    SEQ ID NO: 154 Ac-ca(dHar)(dHar)(dHar)ar-NH2 2.7
    *Method set forth in Example 7
    Abbreviations: See Example 7
  • To further evaluate the relationship between compound structure and histamine release, a series of compounds was prepared assessed for their ability to trigger induction of histamine in an in vivo assays. The data is shown in Table 10.
  • TABLE 10
    In vivo Histamine Induction
    of Exemplary Peptide Compounds
    * Histamine
    response in vivo
    Fold change from
    pre-dose levels
    Compound
    5′ post injection
    SEQ ID NO. Structure 2 mg/kg IV bolus
    Saline Saline 1.0
    SEQ ID NO: 6 Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 2.7
    SEQ ID NO: 26 Ac-carrrar-NH2 1.0
    SEQ ID NO: 25 Ac-crrarar-NH2 0.9
    SEQ ID NO: 15 Ac-cararrr-NH2 1.0
    SEQ ID NO: 18 Ac-crararr-NH2 1.1
    SEQ ID NO: 20 Ac-crarrra-NH2 1.0
    SEQ ID NO: 19 Ac-carrrra-NH2 0.9
    SEQ ID NO: 23 Ac-crarrar-NH2 0.8
    SEQ ID NO: 18 Ac-crararr-NH2 1.0
    SEQ ID NO: 27 Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH2 0.9
    SEQ ID NO: 28 Ac-c(C)rrarar-NH2 0.9
    *Method set forth in Example 7.
  • Accordingly, and as can be appreciated in view of the PTH data and the histamine data described hereinabove, in one embodiment, a compound that has activity to decrease PTH level in a subject in the absence of a histamine response is contemplated. In certain embodiments, absence of a histamine response intends a dose of the compound that produces a less than 10-fold, more preferably 8-fold, still more preferably 5-fold, and even still more preferably 3-fold, increase in histamine, measured in vitro in an assay as described herein, where the fold change is determined based on histamine levels before incubation with the compound and after 15 minutes incubation with compound. In a specific embodiment, the histamine response is determined in an in vitro assay using rat peritoneal mast cells isolated from peritoneal lavage of normal Sprague Dawley rats, and where the fold change is determined based on histamine levels before incubation with the compound and after 15 minutes incubation with compound. In the studies conducted herein, the in vitro evaluation of histamine release was performed using isolated rat peritoneal mast cells isolated by peritoneal lavage using cold HBSS+25 mM HEPES pH 7.4 containing heparin (5 u/mL). Cells were washed twice in stimulation buffer (HBSS+25 mM HEPES pH 7.4) and incubated with 10 μM of compound in stimulation buffer (HBSS+25 mM HEPES pH 7.4) for 15 minutes in a 96-well plate (106/well) at 37° C. Cell supernatant was analyzed for histamine using histamine EIA kit (Cayman #589651).
  • In another embodiment, a compound that has activity to decrease PTH level in a subject in the absence of an clinical histamine response is contemplated. As used herein, absence of a “clinical histamine response” intends is that a therapeutically effective amount of a compound as described herein is administered to the subject without producing a clinically adverse increase in plasma or blood histamine as measured 5-10 minutes after completion of dosing or over the course of treatment. For example, when a compound required to produce a desired therapeutic effect is administered to a subject by bolus (as used herein “bolus” means administered over one minute or less) produced an increase in plasma or blood histamine 5-10 minutes after completion of dosing that is less than 15-fold, 10-fold, 9-fold, 8-fold, 7-fold, 6-fold, 5-fold, 4-fold, 3-fold, 2-fold above pre-dose levels.
  • As can be appreciated from the studies described above, in one embodiment, the compound comprises a sequence of 3 to 35 amino acid residues, wherein a plurality of positively charged amino acid residue subunits is present in the sequence. In some embodiments, the described compounds comprise 5 to 25 subunits, and in a preferred embodiment each subunit is an amino acid residue. In other embodiments, the described compounds comprise 6 to 12 subunits. In still other embodiments, the described compounds comprise 3 to 9 amino acid subunits. In alternative embodiments the described compounds comprise 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23, 24, 25, 26, 27, 28, 29, 30, 31, 32, 33, 34, or 35 subunits.
  • The subunits of the described compounds are, in one embodiment, independently selected from natural or unnatural amino acids, or their analogs, and may have either the L- or D-configuration (except for glycine which is achiral). Glycine, the aliphatic residues alanine, valine, leucine, or isoleucine, proline, the hydroxyl residues serine and threonine, the acidic residues aspartic acid and glutamic acid, the amide residues asparagine, and glutamine, the basic residues lysine and arginine, histidine, the aromatic residues phenylalanine, tyrosine, and tryptophan, and the sulfur-containing residues methionine and cysteine are all contemplated for use in the described compounds. The number of positively charged subunits, and their density can affect the potency of the compound for reducing PTH. In some embodiments, positively charged subunits are separated by one or more other subunits (“separating subunits”). In one embodiment, the separating subunits are alanine residues. In some embodiments, the chirality of the separating subunit affects the potency of the compound.
  • Positively charged amino acid residues of the described compounds may be a specific natural or unnatural residue, or analog thereof, having either the L- or D-configuration (e.g., L-arginine) that is repeated in the sequence, or may be a variety of natural or unnatural residues, or analogs thereof, having either the L- or D-configuration. In some embodiments, the compound is a peptide comprised of from 3 to 20 positively charged amino acid residues, 6 to 12 positively charged amino acid residues, 3 to 9 positively charged amino acid residues. In some embodiments, the peptides comprise 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, or 20 positively charged amino acid residues.
  • In some embodiments, the positively charged amino acid residues are independently selected from natural amino acids. In some embodiments, the positively charged amino acid residues are independently selected from natural and/or unnatural amino acids. In some embodiments, the positively charged amino acid residues are independently selected from the group consisting of arginine, lysine, histidine, 2,3-diaminopropionic acid (Dap), 2,4-diaminobutyric acid (Dab), ornithine, and homoarginine. In a preferred embodiment, the positively charged amino acid residues are arginine residues.
  • In some embodiments, the compound is a peptide and is a single continuous peptide chain or strand. In other embodiments, the compound is a peptide that is branched. In still other embodiments, the peptide is conjugated to one or more thiol-containing moieties (each, a “thiol-containing conjugating group” or a “conjugating group”). In a preferred embodiment, and as merely illustrative, the peptide compound is conjugated to a Cys conjugating group, via a (—S—S—) disulfide bond (for example -Cys-Cys-). As used herein, the term “compound” is intended to encompass both such peptides and such conjugates.
  • The compounds typically comprise one or more thiol moieties, preferably one or more reactive thiol moieties. Subunits that have a thiol group include non-amino acid compounds having a thiol group and amino acids with a thiol group. The thiol group of the thiol-containing subunit may be in a conjugated form (e.g., via a disulfide bond to a conjugating group) or in an unconjugated form (i.e., as a reduced thiol). In a preferred embodiment, when the thiol group is in either an unconjugated form or a conjugated form, it is capable of forming a disulfide bond with a thiol-containing group. The thiol-containing residue may be located at any position along the peptide chain, including the amino terminus, the carboxy terminus, or some other position. In a preferred embodiment, the thiol-containing residue or subunit may be located at the amino terminus. In other embodiments, the thiol-containing residue or subunit may be located at the carboxy terminus or within the peptide sequence.
  • Some representative examples of thiol-containing residues include, without limitation, cysteine, mercaptopropionic acid, homo-cysteine, and penicillamine. When the thiol-containing residue contains a chiral center, it may be present in the L- or D-configuration. In a preferred embodiment, the thiol-containing residue is cysteine.
  • In some embodiments, the cross-linkage between the thiol containing subunit at the X1 position in the compound and the thiol-containing conjugating group may be cleavable and/or exchangeable with other thiol-containing conjugating groups such as cysteine (e.g., by reduction of the disulfide linkage) in vivo to yield a biologically active form of the compound. In this way, the conjugate may function as a pro-drug of the compound. A conjugating group also may be used to modify the physicochemical, pharmacokinetic and/or pharmacodynamic properties of the described compounds (e.g., conjugation via a disulfide linkage to a large PEGylated moiety to enhance the pharmacokinetics).
  • In some embodiments, the compound is a peptide comprised of the amino acid sequence (Xaa1)-(Xaa2)-(Xaa3)-(Xaa4)-(Xaa5)-(Xaa6)-(Xaa7) (SEQ ID NO:155), wherein (Xaa1) is a thiol-containing amino acid residue, (Xaa2) is a non-cationic amino acid residue, (Xaa3) is any amino acid residue, (Xaa4) is any amino acid residue, (Xaa5) is a cationic amino acid residue, (Xaa6) is a non-cationic residue, and (Xaa7) is any amino acid residue. The peptide may be modified at the N-terminus, the C-terminus, or both. In a preferred embodiment, the peptide is modified at both the N-terminus and C-terminus by acetylation and amidation, respectively.
  • In some embodiments, a peptide comprises the amino acid sequence (D-Cys)-(Xaa2)-(Xaa3)-(Xaa4)-(Xaa5)-(Xaa6)-(Xaa7) (SEQ ID NO:156), wherein (Xaa2) is a non-cationic amino acid residue, (Xaa3) is any amino acid residue, (Xaa4) is any amino acid residue, (Xaa5) is selected from the group consisting of D-Arg, L-Arg, D-Lys and L-Lys, (Xaa6) is a non-cationic residue, and (Xaa7) is any amino acid residue. The peptide may have an N-terminal cap, a C-terminal cap, or both. In a preferred embodiment, the peptide has both an N-terminal cap and a C-terminal cap.
  • In some embodiments, a peptide comprises the amino acid sequence (D-Cys)-(Xaa2)-(Xaa3)-(Xaa4)-(Xaa5)-(Xaa6)-(Xaa7) (SEQ ID NO:157), wherein (Xaa2), (Xaa3) and (Xaa4) are, independently, any amino acid residue (but in a preferred embodiment are, independently, selected from the group consisting of D-Ala, D-Val, D-Leu, D-NorVal, and D-NorLeu), (Xaa5) and (Xaa7) are, independently, any cationic amino acid residue (but in a preferred embodiment are, independently, selected from the group consisting of D-Arg, L-Arg, D-Lys and L-Lys), (Xaa6) is a non-cationic amino acid residue (in a preferred embodiment, selected from the group consisting of D-Ala, D-Val, D-Leu, D-NorVal and D-NorLeu). The peptide may have an N-terminal cap, a C-terminal cap, or both. In a preferred embodiment, the peptide has both an N-terminal cap and a C-terminal cap.
  • In some embodiments, a peptide comprises the amino acid sequence (D-Cys)-(Xaa2)-(Xaa3)-(Xaa4)-(Xaa5)-(Xaa6)-(Xaa7) (SEQ ID NO:158), wherein (Xaa2) is a non-cationic amino acid residue, (Xaa3) is any amino acid residue, (Xaa4) is any amino acid residue, (Xaa5) is selected from the group consisting of D-Arg, L-Arg, D-Lys and L-Lys, (Xaa6) is a non-cationic residue, and (Xaa7) is any amino acid residue. The peptide may have an N-terminal cap, a C-terminal cap, or both. In a preferred embodiment, the peptide has both an N-terminal cap and a C-terminal cap.
  • In some embodiments, a peptide comprises the amino acid sequence (D-Cys)-(D-Ala)-(Xaa3)-(Xaa4)-(D-Arg)-(D-Ala)-(Xaa7) (SEQ ID NO:159), wherein (Xaa3) is any cationic amino acid residue, (Xaa4) is any cationic amino acid residue, and (Xaa7) is any cationic amino acid residue. The peptide may have an N-terminal cap, a C-terminal cap, or both. In a preferred embodiment, the peptide has both an N-terminal cap and a C-terminal cap.
  • In some embodiments, a peptide comprises the amino acid sequence (D-Cys)-(Xaa2)-(Xaa3)-(D-Ala)-(D-Arg)-(D-Ala)-(Xaa7) (SEQ ID NO:160), wherein (Xaa2), (Xaa3) and (Xaa7) are, independently, any cationic amino acid residue. The peptide may have an N-terminal cap, a C-terminal cap, or both. In a preferred embodiment, the peptide has both an N-terminal cap and a C-terminal cap.
  • Another embodiment is a calcimimetic peptide, comprising a sequence of amino acids linked by peptide bonds, wherein the sequence comprises 5 to 10 amino acid residues, and wherein the sequence comprises an amino terminus, a carboxy terminus, at least one thiol-containing residue, and from 3 to 9 positively charged residues. In one embodiment, the at least one thiol-containing residue is a cysteine residue. In another aspect, the cysteine residue is positioned at the amino terminus of the peptide. In certain embodiment, the cysteine residue is an L-Cys residue, a D-Cys residue, or an L- or D-homoCys residue. In other embodiments, the amino acid residues of the peptide are D-amino acids or L-amino acids.
  • Also encompassed within the scope of the claimed compounds are peptidomimetic molecules that comprise approximately seven subunits, wherein at least one subunit contains a thiol moiety, preferably a reactive thiol moiety, and other subunits are a plurality of non-cationic subunits, and from 1 to 4 positively charged subunits. Such peptidomimetic molecules may comprise non-peptide bonds between two or more of the subunits. The various features of the compounds discussed above apply generally to the peptidomimetic molecule. For example, as discussed above, the subunits used to construct the molecules can be naturally-occurring amino acids, or residues with non-natural side chains, the termini of the modules can be capped or non-capped in the manner discussed above. Similarly, the amino acid residues of the molecule can be L- or D-amino acid residues. Also as discussed above, the thiol-containing residues can be in a reduced or oxidized form with any of the thiol-containing moieties discussed above.
  • Many peptidomimetic frameworks and methods for their synthesis have been developed (Babine, R. E.; Bender, S. L., Chem. Rev., 97:1359, 1997; Hanessian, S.; et al., Tetrahedron, 53:12789, 1997; Fletcher, M. D.; Cambell, M. C., Chem. Rev., 98:763, 1998); Peptidomimetics Protocols; Kazmierski W. M., Ed.; Methods in Molecular Medicine Series, Vol. 23; Humana Press, Inc.; Totowa, N.J. (1999).
  • Conjugates
  • In some embodiments, the compound is chemically cross-linked to a thiol-containing conjugating group via a disulfide bond between the thiol of the compound and a thiol from the conjugating group. The thiol-containing conjugating group can be a small molecule, such as cysteine, or a macromolecule, such as a polypeptide containing a cysteine residue. Examples of suitable thiol-containing conjugating groups include cysteine, glutathione, thioalkyl, moieties such as thiobenzyl, mercaptopropionic acid, N-acetylated cysteine, cysteamide, N-acetylcysteamide, homocysteine, penicillamine and poly (ethylene glycol) (PEG) modified (referred to as “PEGylated”) thiols such as PEGylated cysteine or a duplication of the compound (i.e., to form a homodimer linked by a disulfide linkage). In a preferred embodiment, the thiol-containing conjugating group is cysteine. Other cysteine homologs are also contemplated for use as thiol-containing conjugating groups, either alone or comprised in a larger conjugating group. Similarly, stereoisomers of cysteine, homocysteine, and cysteamide are suitable for use as thiol-containing moieties. Conjugating groups can be used to improve chemical stability and therefore shelf-life of a pharmaceutical product. In certain embodiments the thiol-containing conjugating group and the peptide are the same (i.e., the conjugate is a dimer), which unexpectedly showed very good chemical stability compared to heterologous conjugating group such as cysteine. Without being bound by theory, presumably when the thiol-containing conjugating group and the peptide are the same, then any disproportionation (e.g., scrambling of the conjugating group) will reconstitute the original dimer compound. In contrast, disproportionation of a compound with a heterologous conjugating group such as cysteine can lead to formation of homo-dimers of the peptide plus cystine (cysteine-cysteine homodimer) plus residual parent compound. A homo-dimer of the peptide (i.e., conjugating group and the peptide are the same) would be converted to a cysteine conjugated form of the peptide in vivo due to the high concentration of reduced cysteine in systemic circulation.
  • In some embodiments, the teachings include a disulfide conjugate of a thiol-containing conjugating group and a peptide comprising the amino acid sequence (Xaa1)-(Xaa2)-(Xaa3)-(Xaa4)-(Xaa5)-(Xaa6)-(Xaa7) (SEQ ID NO:155), wherein (Xaa1) is an amino acid residue with a thiol-containing moiety, (Xaa2) is a non-cationic amino acid residue, (Xaa3) is any amino acid residue, (Xaa4) is any amino acid residue, (Xaa5) is a cationic amino acid residue, (Xaa6) is a non-cationic residue, and (Xaa7) is any amino acid residue. The peptide may have an N-terminal cap, a C-terminal cap, or both. In a preferred embodiment, the peptide has both an N-terminal cap and a C-terminal cap. In a preferred embodiment, the thiol-containing conjugating group is selected from the group consisting of D-Cys, L-Cys, a peptide containing D-Cys, and a peptide containing L-Cys. When the thiol-containing conjugate group is an amino acid or a peptide, it may have an N-terminal cap, a C-terminal cap, or both. In a preferred embodiment, the thiol-containing conjugate group has both an N-terminal cap and a C-terminal cap. In some embodiments, the thiol-containing conjugating group is itself a peptide comprising the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO:155. In some embodiments, the thiol-containing conjugating group and the peptide are the same (i.e., the conjugate is a dimer).
  • In some embodiments, the teachings include a conjugate of a thiol-containing conjugating group and a peptide comprising the amino acid sequence (D-Cys)-(Xaa2)-(Xaa3)-(Xaa4)-(Xaa5)-(Xaa6)-(Xaa7) (SEQ ID NO:156), wherein (Xaa2) is a non-cationic amino acid residue, (Xaa3) is any amino acid residue, (Xaa4) is any amino acid residue, (Xaa5) is selected from the group consisting of D-Arg, L-Arg, D-Lys and L-Lys, (Xaa6) is a non-cationic residue, and (Xaa7) is any amino acid residue. The peptide may have an N-terminal cap, a C-terminal cap, or both. In a preferred embodiment, the peptide has both an N-terminal cap and a C-terminal cap. In a preferred embodiment, the thiol-containing conjugating group is selected from the group consisting of D-Cys, L-Cys, a peptide containing D-Cys, and a peptide containing L-Cys. When the thiol-containing conjugate group is an amino acid or a peptide, it may have an N-terminal cap, a C-terminal cap, or both. In a preferred embodiment, the thiol-containing conjugate group has both an N-terminal cap and a C-terminal cap. In some embodiments, the thiol-containing conjugating group is itself a peptide comprising the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO:156. In some embodiments, the thiol-containing conjugating group and the peptide are the same (i.e., the conjugate is a dimer).
  • In some embodiments, the teachings include a conjugate of a thiol-containing conjugating group and a peptide comprising the amino acid sequence (L-Cys)-(Xaa2)-(Xaa3)-(Xaa4)-(Xaa5)-(Xaa6)-(Xaa7) (SEQ ID NO:183), wherein (Xaa2) is a non-cationic amino acid residue, (Xaa3) is any amino acid residue, (Xaa4) is any amino acid residue, (Xaa5) is selected from the group consisting of D-Arg, L-Arg, D-Lys and L-Lys, (Xaa6) is a non-cationic residue, and (Xaa7) is any amino acid residue. The peptide may have an N-terminal cap, a C-terminal cap, or both. In a preferred embodiment, the peptide has both an N-terminal cap and a C-terminal cap. In a preferred embodiment, the thiol-containing conjugating group is selected from the group consisting of D-Cys, L-Cys, a peptide containing D-Cys, and a peptide containing L-Cys. When the thiol-containing conjugate group is an amino acid or a peptide, it may have an N-terminal cap, a C-terminal cap, or both. In a preferred embodiment, the thiol-containing conjugate group has both an N-terminal cap and a C-terminal cap. In some embodiments, the thiol-containing conjugating group is itself a peptide comprising the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO:183. In some embodiments, the thiol-containing conjugating group and the peptide are the same (i.e., the conjugate is a dimer).
  • In some embodiments, the teachings include a conjugate of a thiol-containing conjugating group and a peptide comprising the amino acid sequence (D-Cys)-(D-Ala)-(Xaa3)-(Xaa4)-(D-Arg)-(D-Ala)-(Xaa7) (SEQ ID NO:161), wherein (Xaa3) is any amino acid residue, (Xaa4) is any amino acid residue, and (Xaa7) is any amino acid residue. The peptide may have an N-terminal cap, a C-terminal cap, or both. In a preferred embodiment, the peptide has both an N-terminal cap and a C-terminal cap. In a preferred embodiment, the thiol-containing conjugating group is selected from the group consisting of D-Cys, L-Cys, a peptide containing D-Cys, and a peptide containing L-Cys. When the thiol-containing conjugate group is an amino acid or a peptide, it may have an N-terminal cap, a C-terminal cap, or both. In a preferred embodiment, the thiol-containing conjugate group has both an N-terminal cap and a C-terminal cap. In some embodiments, the thiol-containing conjugating group is itself a peptide comprising the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO:161. In some embodiments, the thiol-containing conjugating group and the peptide are the same (i.e., the conjugate is a dimer).
  • III. Methods of Use
  • In one aspect, methods to prevent, treat or ameliorate hyperparathyroidism, bone disease and/or other hypercalcemic disorders by administering the compounds described herein are contemplated. As illustrated above, the compounds have activity to decrease PTH and/or calcium levels in a target tissue or tissues, or in a subject. In certain embodiments, the described compounds are capable of decreasing PTH and/or calcium levels when a therapeutically effective amount of the compound is administered to a subject in need of such treatment. The methods of use will now be described with reference to Examples 3 and 8-11.
  • With reference again to Example 3, and as discussed above with respect to Table 1, the series of compounds where a cationic (arginine) residue was sequentially replaced with a non-cationic residue (alanine) were administered to rats. FIG. 5 shows the time profile of each compound's ability to reduce blood PTH and the duration of action of the varying compounds. In FIG. 5, the compounds Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:6, diamonds), Ac-carrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:8, squares) and Ac-crrarrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:10, x symbols) and Ac-crrrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:12, circles) were potent in vivo, as evidenced by the decrease in percent PTH of predose baseline to essentially zero and provided a duration of potency, where the PTH blood concentration remained decreased for at least four hours. The compounds Ac-crarrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:9, triangles), Ac-crrrarr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:11, * symbols) and Ac-crrrrra-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:13, + symbols) decreased percent PTH of baseline for about 2-3 hours, and thereafter the blood concentration of PTH began to increase. Substitution of the cationic (arginine) residue at subunit positions 5 or 7 of Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:6) impacted the duration of PTH lowering activity.
  • The profile of PTH reduction for a series of compounds containing double amino acid substitutions was also evaluated. Selected compounds set forth in Table 2, above, were administered to normal rats by IV bolus at a dose of 0.5 mg/kg and the reduction in PTH relative to predose PTH blood level was evaluated. Data are shown in FIGS. 6A-6B, where the compound are identified as follows: Ac-carrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:26, open diamonds), Ac-crrarar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:25, open squares), Ac-caarrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:22, triangles), Ac-crraarr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:17, circles), Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:3, diamonds FIG. 6B), Ac-c(C)rrarar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:28, x symbols, FIG. 6B).
  • Another study was done to further evaluate the potency of the compound Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO: 3). The compound was intravenously administered to normal rats, as detailed in Example 2, at doses of 1 mg/kg, 0.5 mg/kg, 0.3 mg/kg, and 0.1 mg/kg. Plasma PTH levels were assessed prior to dosing and for 4 hours thereafter. FIG. 7 shows the results, where the PTH blood concentration is shown as percent of the baseline pre-dose value. A dose-related PTH reduction was observed following a single IV bolus administration with the highest dose of 1 mg/kg (diamonds) had the largest reduction in PTH, followed by the 0.5 mg/kg (squares), 0.3 mg/kg (triangles), and 0.1 mg/kg (x symbols). The saline control is shown by the circles symbols. As seen, the peptide when administered at a therapeutically effective dose achieves a reduction in PTH of greater than 50% relative to the concentration of PTH before dosing (“baseline”). Specifically, the peptide when administered at doses of greater than 0.1 mg/kg reduced PTH concentration to less than 90% of the baseline PTH concentration 1 hour after IV administration. These doses of the peptide identified as SEQ ID NO:3 also achieved an area under the curve (AUC) of less than 50%, the AUC calculated as the sum of the PTH concentration values at the time points of 1, 2, 3 and 4 hours, normalized by the AUC for the saline control at the same time points, multiplied by 100.
  • The same compound was also tested in subjects (rats) with renal insufficiency. In this study, the 1K1C model of acute renal insufficiency was used to evaluate a the compound Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH2(SEQ ID NO: 3) to characterize its PTH-lowering activity in a renal dysfunction environment. The model is described in Example 1A. The compound was intravenously administered as a bolus to renally compromised animals (rats) at doses of 3 mg/kg (n=2), 1 mg/kg (n=5), 0.5 mg/kg (n=6) and 0.3 mg/kg (n=5). A control group of animals was dosed with saline. Plasma PTH levels were assessed prior to dosing and for several hours thereafter. FIG. 8 shows the results, where the saline treated animals (squares) had an increased PTH concentration relative to the starting PTH level. At various doses of SEQ ID NO:3, a dose-dependent effect was observed on the duration and extent of PTH reduction. Animals treated with the lowest dose of 0.3 mg/kg (x symbols) exhibiting reduced PTH at the earliest time point and an increase in PTH between hours 1-24 after dosing. The dose levels of 3 mg/kg (diamonds), 1 mg/kg (triangles) and 0.5 mg/kg (squares) provided a reduced PTH blood concentration for more than 15 hours, and for the highest dose, for more than 24 hours.
  • In another study to evaluate the effect of substituting cationic subunits with uncharged subunits, as exemplified by alanine amino acid residues, in the context of a subject with renal insufficiency, an analog of Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:6) was generated and tested for its ability to lower PTH in 1K1C model animals following a 1 mg/kg single intravenous administration. In the tested analog Ac-carrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:26), the cationic subunits at positions X2 and X6 of Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:6) were substituted with uncharged amino acids.
  • As shown in FIG. 9, Ac-carrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:26, open squares) shows activity that is equivalent to Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:6, open diamonds) at the dose tested (1 mg/kg) with similar extended duration of action over 24 hours. The analog of Ac-crrrrrr-NH2(SEQ ID NO:6) with uncharged subunit substitutions was found to retain activity and may, in fact, have in vivo potency and duration of action superior to that of the compound identified as SEQ ID NO:6. In the compound, Ac-carrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:26), D-Arg residues at positions X2 and X6 were substituted with D-Ala residues relative to the compound identified as SEQ ID NO:6.
  • Significantly, as discussed above, administration of the compound Ac-carrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:26) was not accompanied with histamine release, an undesirable side-effect that is seen with Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:6) and other similar compounds when administered at higher doses (>1 mg/kg) by IV bolus. The marked attenuation of the histamine release with the compound identified SEQ ID NO:26 increases the therapeutic margin between the desired PTH-lowering activity and the undesired histamine-inducing activity following administration by IV bolus. Accordingly, in a preferred embodiment, compounds having activity to reduce PTH concentration in vivo in the absence of a histamine response are provided. Accordingly, in one embodiment, a compound is provided that has activity to decrease PTH where the compound when administered and a subject, human or otherwise, decreases PTH level to below 50% of the pre-dose level within one hour after dosing. In a specific embodiment, a compound that has significant activity to decrease PTH intends a compound that when administered to a normal rate decreases PTH level to below 50% of the pre-dose level within one hour after dosing by IV bolus.
  • In another study, detailed in Example 8, compounds in the form of a conjugate, where the thiol-containing subunit in position X1 was linked through a disulfide linkage to an L-Cys residue. These compounds have the following structures:
  • Figure US20200399309A1-20201224-C00011
  • In the notation used herein, the compound that is linked to the thiol-containing moiety in the X1 subunit is identified parenthetically, where in these exemplary conjugates the compound L-Cys is indicated (C) is linked to the thiol-containing moiety in the X1 subunit: Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:3) and Ac-c(Ac-C)arrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:141). These compounds were administered via IV bolus to animals with acute renal insufficiency (1K1C model) at doses of 0.3 and 0.5 mg/kg, and the results are shown in FIG. 10. The compound Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:3) is represented by squares (0.3 mg/kg, n=5) and * symbols (0.5 mg/kg, n=6) and the compound Ac-c(Ac-C)arrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:141) by triangles (0.3 mg/kg, n=8) and diamonds (0.5 mg/kg, n=7). This in vivo dose response with SEQ ID NO:3 displays a dose-dependent reduction in PTH very similar to Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:6).
  • In some of the in vivo studies described herein, the compounds, including compounds in conjugate form where the thiol in the X1 subunit is cross-linked via a disulfide bond to another subunit, were administered as a 30-minute IV infusion. However, it should be noted that shorter infusions (e.g., <5 minutes) or delivery by IV bolus typically produce comparable pharmacodynamic reduction of PTH as a longer 30-minute infusion. Subcutaneous bolus administration also proved to be an efficacious route of delivery that generated a smaller initial drop in PTH but displayed a sustained reduction in PTH similar to the profile seen by the IV route. As shown in FIG. 11, the compound Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:6), was also administered by micropore-facilitated (e.g., microporation of the stratum corneum) transdermal delivery, and demonstrated a reduction in plasma PTH for the several hours it was monitored. The compound Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:6), was also administered by the transdermal route after microporation resulting in a reduction in plasma PTH for several hours. Transdermal delivery of Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:6) provides an addition option for clinical delivery of the described compounds.
  • To evaluate the effect of administration route on the activity of Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:6) in the context of a subject with renal insufficiency, rats in the 1K1C model were given 1 mg/kg of the peptide as either a subcutaneous (SC) bolus or a 30-minute IV infusion. Both routes of administration effectively reduced plasma PTH levels for over 24 hours. When Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:6) was delivered by IV infusion, PTH levels fell rapidly by 80-90% from baseline. By 16 hours after dosing, PTH levels had started to rise although they were still reduced by ˜80% from baseline. When Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:6) was delivered by SC bolus, PTH levels exhibited a more moderate initial drop to ˜40% of baseline, but exhibited a similar duration of reduction as when the peptide was delivered by the IV route. Twenty-four hours after dosing, PTH levels in animals dosed by either route had partially rebounded although both still displayed reduced PTH levels that were ˜40-60% from baseline. The results showed that this route of administration provides a similar profile with respect to efficacy and duration of PTH reduction as IV administration, thus providing an alternative path for clinical dosing (data not shown).
  • Accordingly, in a preferred embodiment, a subject having secondary hyperparathyroidism (SHPT) is treated using the described compounds to reduce plasma PTH levels and/or calcium. Untreated SHPT patients with moderately severe hyperparathyroidism often have baseline circulating intact PTH levels >300 μg/ml, and levels that can exceed 600 μg/mL. In a preferred embodiment, the decrease in PTH levels is measured as a decrease in intact PTH below pretreatment baseline levels. In another embodiment the desired decrease in PTH is to bring the plasma PTH levels into generally recognized guidelines established by the National Kidney Foundation or other experts in the treatment of kidney disorders and renal insufficiency.
  • In another aspect, methods for treating hyperparathyroidism, hypercalcemia and/or bone disease are provided, comprising administering a therapeutically effective amount of a described compound. In another embodiment, the subject can be treated with a described compound in combination with one or more other therapeutically effective agents.
  • In another aspect, the described compound is administered in an amount effective to reduce PTH or PTH effect. In some embodiments, the reduction in plasma PTH is at least 1%, 2%, 3%, 4%, 5%, 6%, 7%, 8%, 9%, 10%, 11%, 12%, 13%, 14%, 15%, 16%, 17%, 18%, 19%, 20%, 25% or 30% below pretreatment baseline levels for at least 10 hours post administration of the described compound. In specific embodiments, the reduction in plasma PTH is at least 20% at 10 hours post administration. In preferred embodiments, the reduction in plasma PTH is 15 to 40%, preferably 20 to 50%, more preferably 30 to 70% below pretreatment baseline levels for at least 48 hours post administration of the described compound.
  • In another aspect, the described compound is administered in an amount effective to decrease serum calcium or calcium effect. In some embodiments, the reduction in serum calcium is at least 1%, 2%, 3%, 4%, 5%, 6%, 7%, 8%, 9%, 10%, 11%, 12%, 13%, 14%, 15%, 16%, 17%, 18%, 19%, 20% or 25% below pretreatment levels for at least 10 hours post administration of the polycationic peptide. In some preferred embodiments, the reduction in serum calcium is at least 5% at 10 hours post administration. In some preferred embodiments, the reduction is serum calcium is 5 to 10%, preferably 5 to 20% below pretreatment levels for at least 48 hours post administration of the described compound.
  • In another aspect, a method for treating hyperparathyroidism and/or hypercalcemia in a subject in need thereof is provided, comprising: administering a therapeutically effective amount of a described compound, whereby PTH and/or calcium is reduced.
  • Based on the relationship between serum calcium, bone metabolism and PTH, it is thought that the described compounds are beneficial for the treatment of various forms of bone disease and/or hypercalcemia in addition to hyperparathyroidism. The described compounds may have advantages compared to current therapeutic agents, because they may be administered parenterally and may not be associated with gastrointestinal adverse effects, are not metabolized by cytochrome P450 and may result in more effective reductions in plasma PTH and calcium.
  • As discussed above, the described methods may be used alone or in combination with one or more other therapeutically effective agents. Such other therapeutically effective agents include, but are not limited to, treatment with antiresorptive bisphosphonate agents, such as alendronate and risedronate; integrin blockers, such as αvβ3 antagonists; conjugated estrogens used in hormone replacement therapy, such as PREMPRO™, PREMARIN™ and ENDOMETRION™; selective estrogen receptor modulators (SERMs), such as raloxifene, droloxifene, CP-336,156 (Pfizer) and lasofoxifene; cathespin K inhibitors; vitamin D therapy; vitamin D analogs, such as ZEMPLAR™ (paricalcitol); CALCIJEX® (calcitriol), HECTOROL® (doxercalciferol), ONE-ALPHA® (alfacalcidol) and the analogs in development from Cytochroma known as CTA-018, CTAP201 and CTAP101, other calcimimetics such as Sensipar® (cinacalcet); inhibitors of type II sodium-dependent phosphate transporter family, SLC34 (including the two renal isoforms NaPi-IIa and NaPi-IIc, and the intestinal NaPi-IIb transporter); phosphatonins (including FGF-23, sFRP4, MEPE or FGF-7); low dose PTH treatment (with or without estrogen); calcitonin; inhibitors of RANK ligand; antibodies against RANK ligand, osteoprotegrin; adensosine antagonists; and ATP proton pump inhibitors.
  • In one embodiment, a described compound is administered at a dose sufficient to decrease both PTH and serum calcium levels. In another embodiment, a described compound is administered at a dose sufficient to decrease PTH without significantly affecting serum calcium levels. In a further embodiment, a described compound is administered at a dose sufficient to increase PTH without significantly affecting serum calcium levels.
  • Formulations
  • A pharmaceutical composition comprising a described compound and at least one pharmaceutically acceptable excipient or carrier is provided. Methods of preparing such pharmaceutical compositions typically comprise the step of bringing into association a described compound with a carrier and, optionally, one or more accessory ingredients. The described compounds and/or pharmaceutical compositions comprising same may be formulated into pharmaceutically-acceptable dosage forms by conventional methods known to those of skill in the art. Typically, formulations are prepared by uniformly and intimately bringing into association a described compound with liquid carriers, or finely divided solid carriers, or both, and then, if necessary, shaping the product.
  • Pharmaceutical compositions of the present invention suitable for parenteral administration comprise one or more described compounds in combination with one or more pharmaceutically-acceptable sterile isotonic aqueous or nonaqueous solutions, dispersions, suspensions or emulsions, or sterile powders which may be reconstituted into sterile injectable solutions or dispersions just prior to use, which may contain sugars, alcohols, amino acids, antioxidants, buffers, bacteriostats, solutes which render the formulation isotonic with the blood of the intended recipient or suspending or thickening agents.
  • Examples of suitable aqueous and nonaqueous carriers which may be employed in the pharmaceutical compositions of the invention include water, ethanol, polyols (such as glycerol, propylene glycol, polyethylene glycol, and the like), and suitable mixtures thereof, vegetable oils, such as olive oil, and injectable organic esters, such as ethyl oleate. Proper fluidity can be maintained, for example, by the use of coating materials, such as lecithin, by the maintenance of the required particle size in the case of dispersions, and by the use of surfactants.
  • These pharmaceutical compositions may also contain adjuvants such as preservatives, wetting agents, emulsifying agents and dispersing agents. Prevention of the action of microorganisms upon the described compounds may be ensured by the inclusion of various antibacterial and antifungal agents, for example, paraben, chlorobutanol, phenol sorbic acid, and the like. It may also be desirable to include agents to control tonicity, such as sugars, sodium chloride, and the like into the compositions. In addition, prolonged absorption of the injectable pharmaceutical form may be brought about by the inclusion of agents which delay absorption such as aluminum monostearate and gelatin.
  • In some cases, in order to prolong the effect of a drug, it is desirable to slow the absorption of the drug from subcutaneous or intramuscular injection. This may be accomplished by the use of a liquid suspension of crystalline or amorphous material having poor water solubility. The rate of absorption of the drug then depends upon its rate of dissolution which, in turn, may depend upon crystal size and crystalline form. Alternatively, delayed absorption of a parenterally-administered drug form is accomplished by dissolving or suspending the drug in an oil vehicle.
  • For example, a described compound may be delivered to a human in a form of solution that is made by reconstituting a solid form of the drug with liquid. This solution may be further diluted with infusion fluid such as water for injection, 0.9% sodium chloride injection, 5% dextrose injection and lactated ringer's injection. It is preferred that the reconstituted and diluted solutions be used within 4-6 hours for delivery of maximum potency. Alternatively, a described compound may be delivered to a human in a form of tablet or capsule.
  • Injectable depot forms are made by forming microencapsulated matrices of the described compounds in biodegradable polymers such as polylactide-polyglycolide. Depending on the ratio of drug to polymer, and the nature of the particular polymer employed, the rate of drug release can be controlled. Examples of other biodegradable polymers include poly(orthoesters) and poly(anhydrides). Depot injectable formulations are also prepared by entrapping the drug in liposomes or microemulsions which are compatible with body tissue.
  • When the described compounds are administered as pharmaceuticals, to humans and animals, they can be given alone or as a pharmaceutical composition containing, for example, 0.1 to 99% (more preferably, 10 to 30%) of active ingredient in combination with a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier. In other embodiments, the pharmaceutical composition may contain 0.2-25%, preferably 0.5-5% or 0.5-2%, of active ingredient. These compounds may be administered to humans and other animals for therapy by any suitable route of administration, including, e.g., subcutaneous injection, subcutaneous depot, intravenous injection, intravenous or subcutaneous infusion. These compounds may be administered rapidly (within <1 minute) as a bolus or more slowly over an extended period of time (over several minutes, hours or days). These compounds may be delivered daily or over multiple days, continuously or intermittently. In one embodiment, the compounds may be administered transdermally (e.g., using a patch, microneedles, micropores, ointment, microjet or nanojet).
  • Regardless of the route of administration selected, the described compounds, which may be used in a suitable hydrated form, and/or the pharmaceutical compositions, are formulated into pharmaceutically-acceptable dosage forms by conventional methods known to those of skill in the art.
  • Actual dosage levels of the active ingredients in the pharmaceutical compositions may be varied so as to obtain an amount of the active ingredient which is effective to achieve the desired therapeutic response for a particular patient, composition, and mode of administration, without being toxic to the patient.
  • The selected dosage level will depend upon a variety of factors including the activity of the particular described compound employed, or the ester, salt or amide thereof, the route of administration, the time of administration, the rate of excretion or metabolism of the particular compound being employed, the rate and extent of absorption, the duration of the treatment, other drugs, compounds and/or materials used in combination with the particular compound employed, the age, sex, weight, condition, general health and prior medical history of the patient being treated, and like factors well known in the medical arts.
  • A physician or veterinarian having ordinary skill in the art can readily determine and prescribe the effective amount of the pharmaceutical composition required. For example, the physician or veterinarian could start doses of the described compounds employed in the pharmaceutical composition at levels lower than that required in order to achieve the desired therapeutic effect and gradually increase the dosage until the desired effect is achieved.
  • In general, a suitable daily dose of a described compound will be that amount of the compound which is the lowest dose effective to produce a therapeutic effect. Such an effective dose will generally depend upon the factors described above. Generally, intravenous, intramuscular, transdermal, intracerebroventricular and subcutaneous doses of the described compounds for a patient, when used for the indicated effects, will range from about 1 μg to about 5 mg per kilogram of body weight per hour. In other embodiments, the dose will range from about 5 μg to about 2.5 mg per kilogram of body weight per hour. In further embodiments, the dose will range from about 5 μg to about 1 mg per kilogram of body weight per hour.
  • If desired, the effective daily dose of a described compound may be administered as two, three, four, five, six or more sub-doses administered separately at appropriate intervals throughout the day, optionally, in unit dosage forms. In one embodiment, the described compound is administered as one dose per day. In further embodiments, the compound is administered continuously, as through intravenous or other routes. In other embodiments, the compound is administered less frequently than daily, such as every 2-3 days, in conjunction with dialysis treatment, weekly or less frequently.
  • The subject receiving this treatment is any animal in need, including primates, in particular humans, and other mammals such as equines, cattle, swine and sheep; and poultry and pets in general.
  • The described compounds may be administered as such or in admixtures with pharmaceutically acceptable carriers and can also be administered in conjunction with antimicrobial agents such as penicillins, cephalosporins, aminoglycosides and glycopeptides. Conjunctive therapy thus includes sequential, simultaneous and separate administration of the active compound in a way that the therapeutical effects of the first administered one is not entirely disappeared when the subsequent is administered.
  • Routes of Administration for Disclosed Compounds
  • These compounds may be administered to humans and other animals for therapy by any suitable route of administration. As used herein, the term “route” of administration is intended to include, but is not limited to subcutaneous injection, subcutaneous depot, intravenous injection, intravenous or subcutaneous infusion, intraocular injection, intradermal injection, intramuscular injection, intraperitoneal injection, intratracheal administration, intraadiposal administration, intraarticular administration, intrathecal administration, epidural administration, inhalation, intranasal administration, sublingual administration, buccal administration, rectal administration, vaginal administration, intracisternal administration and topical administration, transdermal administration, or administration via local delivery (for example by catheter or stent).
  • Transdermal drug delivery to the body is a desirable and convenient method for systemic delivery of biologically active substances to a subject, and in particular for delivery of substances that have poor oral bioavailability, such as proteins and peptides. The transdermal route of delivery has been particularly successful with small (e.g., less than about 1,000 Daltons) lipophilic compounds, such as scopolamine and nicotine, that can penetrate the stratum corneum outer layer of the skin, which serves as an effective barrier to entry of substances into the body. Below the stratum corneum is the viable epidermis, which contains no blood vessels, but has some nerves. Deeper still is the dermis, which contains blood vessels, lymphatics and nerves. Drugs that cross the stratum corneum barrier can generally diffuse to the capillaries in the dermis for absorption and systemic distribution.
  • Technological advances in transdermal delivery have focused on addressing the need in the art to deliver hydrophilic, high molecular weight compounds, such as proteins and peptides, across the skin. One approach involves disruption of the stratum corneum using chemical or physical methods to reduce the barrier posed by the stratum corneum. Skin microporation technology, which involves the creation of micron dimension transport pathways (micropores) in the skin (in particular, the micropores in the stratum corneum) using a minimally invasive technique, is a more recent approach. Techniques to create micropores in the skin (stratum corneum) include thermal microporation or ablation, microneedle arrays, phonophoresis, laser ablation and radiofrequency ablation (Prausnitz and Langer (2008) Nat. Biotechnology 11:1261-68; Arora et al., Int. J. Pharmaceutics, 364:227 (2008); Nanda et al., Current Drug Delivery, 3:233 (2006); Meidan et al. American J. Therapeutics, 11:312 (2004)).
  • As noted above, PTH secretion is regulated by the CaSR which is expressed on the cell surface of parathyroid cells. Thus, in order to activate the CaSR, the agent or compound must be delivered to the parathyroid cell. Transdermal delivery of calcimimetic agents must achieve delivery across the stratum corneum and provide systemic exposure to reach the parathyroid cell. To date, the art has not demonstrated whether a calcimimetic compound can be delivered transdermally in an amount sufficient for therapeutic benefit and in particular in an amount sufficient for decreasing PTH and/or the treatment, attenuation, lessening and/or relief hypercalcemia.
  • In addition to calcimimetics, 1,25-(OH)2 vitamin D3 analogs are the most commonly used treatments for patients with hyperparathyroidism associated with chronic kidney disease and end stage renal disease. Vitamin D analogs act by facilitating intestinal absorption of dietary calcium, and reduce PTH levels by inhibiting PTH synthesis and secretion. While intravenous and oral delivery of vitamin D has been used therapeutically, to date, the art has not demonstrated whether vitamin D analogs, such as ZEMPLAR™ (paricalcitol), CALCIJEX® (calcitriol), ONE-ALPHA® (alfacalcidol) and HECTOROL® (doxercalciferol) can be delivered transdermally in an amount sufficient for therapeutic benefit and in particular in an amount sufficient for decreasing parathyroid hormone (PTH). In addition, the art has not demonstrated whether the co-administration by transdermal delivery of a calcimimetic agent in combination with a vitamin D analog (either as separate formulations or as a co-formulation) in amounts sufficient for therapeutic benefit, and in particular in amounts sufficient for decreasing PTH and provide effective treatment for patients suffering from hyperparathyroidism.
  • The calcimimetic agents may be administered across the stratum corneum, and/or other layers of the epidermis, for local or systemic delivery, for decreasing parathyroid hormone (PTH) and/or treating hypercalcemia. In one embodiment, the calcimimetic agent is delivered via microporation. Any one of a number of techniques for microporation is contemplated, and several are briefly described.
  • Microporation can be achieved by mechanical means and/or external driving forces, to breach the stratum corneum to deliver the calcimimetic agents described herein through the surface of the skin and into the underlying skin layers and/or the bloodstream.
  • In a first embodiment, the microporation technique is ablation of the stratum corneum in a specific region of the skin using a pulsed laser light of wavelength, pulse length, pulse energy, pulse number, and pulse repetition rate sufficient to ablate the stratum corneum without significantly damaging the underlying epidermis. The calcimimetic agent is then applied to the region of ablation. Another laser ablation microporation technique, referred to as laser-induced stress waves (LISW), involves broadband, unipolar and compressible waves generated by high-power pulsed lasers. The LISWs interact with tissues to disrupt the lipids in the stratum corneum, creating intercellular channels transiently within the stratum corneum. These channel, or micropores, in the stratum corneum permit entry of the calcimimetic agent.
  • Sonophoresis or phonophoresis is another microporation technique that uses ultrasound energy. Ultrasound is a sound wave possessing frequencies above 20 KHz. Ultrasound can be applied either continuously or pulsed, and applied at various frequency and intensity ranges (Nanda et al., Current Drug Delivery, 3:233 (2006)).
  • Another microporation technique involves the use of a microneedle array. The array of microneedles when applied to a skin region on a subject pierce the stratum corneum and do not penetrate to a depth that significantly stimulates nerves or punctures capillaries. The patient, thus, feels no or minimal discomfort or pain upon application of the microneedle array for generation of micropores through which the calcimimetic agent is delivered.
  • Microneedle arrays comprised of hollow or solid microneedles are contemplated, where the calcimimetic agent can be coated on the external surface of the needles or dispensed from the interior of hollow needles. Examples of microneedle arrays are described, for example, in Nanda et al., Current Drug Delivery, 3:233 (2006) and Meidan et al. American J. Therapeutics, 11:312 (2004). First generation microneedle arrays were comprised of solid, silicon microneedles that were externally coated with a therapeutic agent. When the microarray of needles was pressed against the skin and removed after about 10 seconds, the permeation of the agent on the needles into the body was readily achieved. Second generation microneedle arrays were comprised of microneedles of solid or hollow silicon, polycarbonate, titanium or other suitable polymer and coated or filled with a solution of the therapeutic compound. Newer generations of microneedle arrays are prepared from biodegradable polymers, where the tips of the needles coated with a therapeutic agent remain in the stratum corneum and slowly dissolve.
  • The microneedles can be constructed from a variety of materials, including metals, ceramics, semiconductors, organics, polymers, and composites. Exemplary materials of construction include pharmaceutical grade stainless steel, gold, titanium, nickel, iron, tin, chromium, copper, palladium, platinum, alloys of these or other metals, silicon, silicon dioxide, and polymers. Representative biodegradable polymers include polymers of hydroxy acids such as lactic acid and glycolic acid polylactide, polyglycolide, polylactide-co-glycolide, and copolymers with poly(ethylene glycol), polyanhydrides, poly(ortho)esters, polyurethanes, poly(butyric acid), poly(valeric acid), and poly(lactide-co-caprolactone). Representative non-biodegradable polymers include polycarbonate, polyester, and polyacrylamides.
  • The microneedles can have straight or tapered shafts. In one embodiment, the diameter of the microneedle is greatest at the base end of the microneedle and tapers to a point at the end distal the base. The microneedle can also be fabricated to have a shaft that includes both a straight (untapered) portion and a tapered portion. The needles may also not have a tapered end at all, i.e. they may simply be cylinders with blunt or flat tips. A hollow microneedle that has a substantially uniform diameter, but which does not taper to a point, is referred to herein as a “microtube.” As used herein, the term “microneedle” includes both microtubes and tapered needles unless otherwise indicated.
  • Electroporation is another technique for creating micropores in the skin. This approach uses the application of microsecond or millisecond long high-voltage electrical pulses to created transient, permeable pores within the stratum corneum.
  • Other microporation techniques include use of radio waves to create microchannels in the skin. Thermal ablation is yet another approach to achieve delivery of larger molecular weight compounds transdermally.
  • Applicants have discovered that low doses of calcimimetic agents may be therapeutically administered over an extended period of time to treat SHPT. This markedly differs from current dose requirements of other calcimimetics (e.g., cinacalcet hydrochloride).
  • Transdermal delivery of the compounds described herein was demonstrated in the studies described in Examples 9-10. In a first study, the compound Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:6) was administered transdermally to rats in which a small area of the skin was microporated by 5 passes of a 1.0 mm derma roller under moderate pressure. A solution of either Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO: 6) or saline was placed on the microporated area of skin. Blood draws were taken over a 4 hour period and plasma was analyzed for PTH levels by ELISA. The results are shown in FIG. 11, where the plasma PTH is shown as a percent of pre-dose baseline for the saline treated animal (diamonds) and the two animals treated with the test compound (squares, triangles). These data indicate that the compound Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO: 6) can be delivered systemically in sufficient quantities by transdermal route (in this case, micropore-facilitated transdermal delivery) using a derma roller to effectively and significantly reduce PTH levels from baseline for the ˜4 hours that were studies. It should be noted that Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO: 6) has been shown to effectively reduce PTH levels from baseline in the 1K1C rat model of acute renal insufficiency when administered by short IV infusion as well as in normal rats (data not shown).
  • In another study, described in Example 10, the compound Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:3) was administered micropore-facilitated transdermal delivery to normal rats using a transdermal patch. A transdermal patch system containing 10% solution (by weight) of Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:3) in saline was placed over the microporated area and left in place for ˜30 hours. Blood draws were taken from the rats periodically over the 30 hours and plasma samples were analyzed for PTH levels by ELISA. The results are shown in FIG. 12. Surprisingly, these data demonstrate that micropore-facilitated transdermal delivery can achieve sufficient sustained delivery of Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:3) to produce a significant and extended reduction in PTH for >30 hours in rats with normal renal function. These data demonstrate that microporation facilitated transdermal delivery of the conjugate Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:3) using a patch can achieve sufficient blood exposure of the peptide over the course of treatment to produce a significant and sustained reduction in PTH from baseline for >30 hrs. These data demonstrate that transdermal patch delivery on a daily basis or longer would enable treatment of both dialysis and non-hemodialysis patients in need of treatment. For example, CKD (stage 4), primary hyperparathyroidism and secondary hyperparathyroidism (SHPT) in renal transplant patients who are not typically treated with IV drugs, but could be readily treated by a daily transdermal patch via microporation facilitated transdermal delivery.
  • Another study was conducted to further evaluate the route of administration of the compounds. As described in Example 11, the compound Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH2(SEQ ID NO:3) was administered by very low dose IV infusion to normal rats and to rats with renal insufficiency to identify the lowest dose needed to be administered by infusion, transdermal patch system or other sustained delivery means to achieve significant PTH reduction. Healthy rats were intravenously infused for six hours with very low doses (1 μg/kg/hr, 3 μg/kg/hr, and 10 μg/kg/hr) of Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:3). Blood samples were taken prior to dosing (pre) and at 2 hours, 4 hours, 6 hours (just prior to the end of infusion; EOI) and 8 hours (2 hrs post EOI) after the start of infusion and plasma was analyzed for PTH levels by ELISA. Surprisingly, the data shown in FIG. 13 demonstrate that infusion of very low doses of Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:3) (1 μg/kg/hr (squares), 3 μg/kg/hr (circles), and 10 μg/kg/hr (triangles)) for 6 hours are effective to produce significant reduction in PTH from baseline over the course of infusion. These data indicate that low doses delivered continuously could be as effective as (or even more effective than) much larger doses delivery as a single bolus.
  • The PTH lowering effect was further evaluated in the rat 1K1C model of acute renal insufficiency. 1K1C model rats were intravenously infused with low doses of Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:3) (30 μg/kg/hr and 100 μg/kg/hr) for 6 hours. Blood samples were taken prior to dosing (Pre), and at 2 hours, 4 hours, 6 hours (just prior to the end of infusion; EOI), 8 hours (2 hrs post EOI) and 24 hours after the start of infusion and plasma was analyzed for PTH levels by ELISA. The data shown in FIG. 14A demonstrate that IV infusion of low doses of Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:3) significantly reduce PTH from baseline levels in the 1K1C model, a model of renal insufficiency where baseline PTH levels can be seen to be from 400 to >1100 μg/mL. Surprisingly, 6 hours of low dose IV infusion (diamonds, 30 μg/kg/hr and squares, 100 μg/kg/hr) of Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:3) were able to reduce PTH from baseline for ˜24 hours. Consistent with this dramatic PTH reduction in the 1K1C rat model, FIG. 14B shows a bar graph plotting serum calcium data in this acute renal insufficiency, and show a corresponding reduction in serum calcium following low dose IV infusion of Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:3). These data demonstrate that Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:3) is a very potent calcimimetic compound that is able to reduce PTH and calcium following infusion or delivery of low doses (for example by transdermal delivery) over the course of ˜24 hours. These data further support the conclusion that low dose sustained delivery of a calcimimetic agent by IV infusion or by micropore-facilitated transdermal delivery could be an effective treatment for patients on a daily or less frequent basis.
  • Combination Therapy
  • As described above, the methods of use may be used alone or in combination with other approaches for the treatment of hypercalcemia and/or bone disease. Such other approaches include, but are not limited to, treatment with agents such as bisphosphonate agents, integrin blockers, hormone replacement therapy, selective estrogen receptor modulators, cathepsin K inhibitors, vitamin D therapy, vitamin D analogs, such as ZEMPLAR™ (paricalcitol), CALCIJEX® (calcitriol), ONE-ALPHA® (alfacalcidol) and HECTOROL® (doxercalciferol), anti-inflammatory agents, low dose PTH therapy (with or without estrogen), calcimimetics, phosphate binders, calcitonin, inhibitors of RANK ligand, antibodies against RANK ligand, osteoprotegrin, adensosine antagonists and ATP proton pump inhibitors.
  • In one embodiment, a combination therapy uses vitamin D or a vitamin D analog in combination with a calcimimetic agent. Vitamin D aids in the absorption of calcium and functions to maintain normal blood levels of calcium and phosphorous. PTH works to enhance calcium absorption in the intestine by increasing the production of 1,25-(OH)2 vitamin D, the active form of vitamin D. PTH also stimulates phosphorus excretion from the kidney, and increases release from bone.
  • As discussed above, secondary hyperparathyroidism is characterized by an elevation in parathyroid hormone (PTH) associated with inadequate levels of active vitamin D hormone. Vitamin D or a vitamin D analog may be used to reduce elevated PTH levels in treatment of secondary hyperparathryoidism. In one embodiment, the invention includes a pharmaceutical composition comprising a calcimimetic agent and a vitamin D analog.
  • In one embodiment, the invention includes a pharmaceutical composition comprising a calcimimetic agent and ZEMPLAR™ (paricalcitol). Paricalcitol is a synthetic analog of calcitriol, the metabolically active form of vitamin D. The recommended initial dose of Zemplar is based on baseline intact parathyroid hormone (iPTH) levels. If the baseline iPTH level is less than or equal to 500 μg/mL, the daily dose is 1 μg and the “three times a week” dose (to be administered not more than every other day) is 2 μg. If the baseline iPTH is greater than 500 μg/mL, the daily dose is 2 μg, and the “three times a week” does (to be administered not more than every other day) is 4 μg. Thereafter, dosing must be individualized and based on serum plasma iPTH levels, with monitoring of serum calcium and serum phosphorus. Paricalcitol is described in U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,246,925 and 5,587,497.
  • In another embodiment, the invention includes a pharmaceutical composition comprising a calcimimetic agent and CALCIJEX® (calcitriol). Calcitriol is the metabolically active form of vitamin D. The recommended initial dosage for CALCIJEX® (oral) is 0.25 μ/day. This amount may be increased by 0.25 μg/day at 4- to 8-wk intervals. Normal or only slightly reduced calcium levels may respond to dosages of 0.25 μg every other day. For patients on dialysis, the recommended initial dose for CALCIJEX® (IV) is 0.02 μg/kg (1 to 2 μg) 3 times/week, every other day. This amount may be increased by 0.5 to 1 μg, every 2 to 4 wk. Calcitriol is described in U.S. Pat. Nos. 6,051,567 and 6,265,392 and 6,274,169.
  • In one embodiment, a pharmaceutical composition comprising a calcimimetic agent and HECTOROL® (doxercalciferol) is provided. Doxercalciferol is a synthetic analog of vitamin D that undergoes metabolic activation in vivo to form 1α,25-dihydroxyvitamin D2, a naturally occurring, biologically active form of vitamin D. The recommended initial dose of HECTOROL® is 10 μg administered three times weekly at dialysis (approximately every other day). The initial dose should be adjusted, as needed, in order to lower blood iPTH into the range of 150 to 300 μg/mL. The dose may be increased at 8-week intervals by 2.5 μg if iPTH is not lowered by 50% and fails to reach target range. The maximum recommended dose of HECTOROL is 20 μg administered three times a week at dialysis for a total of 60 μg per week. Doxercalciferol is described in U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,602,116 and 5,861,386 and 5,869,473 and 6,903,083.
  • The particular combination of therapies (therapeutics or procedures) to employ in a combination regimen will take into account compatibility of the desired therapeutics and/or procedures and the desired therapeutic effect to be achieved. It will also be appreciated that the therapies employed may achieve a desired effect for the same disorder (for example, an inventive compound may be administered concurrently with another agent used to treat the same disorder), or they may achieve different effects (e.g., control of any adverse effects). As used herein, additional therapeutic agents that are normally administered to treat or prevent a particular disease, or condition, are known as “appropriate for the disease, or condition, being treated”.
  • A combination treatment of the present invention as defined herein may be achieved by way of the simultaneous, sequential or separate administration of the individual components of said treatment.
  • The compounds or pharmaceutically acceptable compositions thereof may also be incorporated into compositions for coating implantable medical devices, bio-erodible polymers, implantable pump, and suppositories. Accordingly, in another aspect, a composition for coating an implantable device comprising a described compound as described generally above is contemplated, and a carrier suitable for coating the implantable device. In still another aspect, included is an implantable device coated with a composition comprising a compound as described generally above, and a carrier suitable for coating said implantable device.
  • Suitable coatings and the general preparation of coated implantable devices are described in U.S. Pat. Nos. 6,099,562; 5,886,026; and 5,304,121. The coatings are typically biocompatible polymeric materials such as a hydrogel polymer, polymethyldisiloxane, polycaprolactone, polyethylene glycol, polylactic acid, ethylene vinyl acetate, and mixtures thereof. The coatings may optionally be further covered by a suitable topcoat of fluorosilicone, polysaccarides, polyethylene glycol, phospholipids or combinations thereof to impart controlled release characteristics in the composition.
  • Potential Clinical Markers for Determining Treatment Efficacy
  • Determination of the effectiveness of a described method of treatment may be determined by a variety of methods.
  • Normal levels of serum calcium are in the range of 8.8 mg/dL to 10.4 mg/dL (2.2 mmol/L to 2.6 mmol/L). In certain cases, the efficacy of treatment may be determined by measurement of serum and urinary markers related to calcium, including but not limited to, total and ionized serum calcium, albumin, plasma PTH, PTHrP, phosphate, vitamin D, and magnesium.
  • In other cases, efficacy may be determined by measurement of bone mineral density (BMD), or by measurement of biochemical markers for bone formation and/or bone resorption in serum or urine. Potential bone formation markers include, but are not limited to, total alkaline phosphatase, bone alkaline phosphatase, osteocalcin, under-carboxylated osteocalcin, C-terminal procollagen type I propeptide, and N-terminal procollagen type I propeptide. Potential bone resorption markers include, but are not limited, hydroxyproline, hydroxylysine, glycosyl-galactosyl hydroxylysine, galactosyl hydroxylysine, pyridinoline, deoxypyridinoline, N-terminal crosslinking telopeptide of type I collagen, C-terminal crosslinking telopeptide of type I collagen, C-terminal crosslinking telopeptide of type I collagen generated by MMPs, bone sialoprotein, acid phosphatase and tartrate-resistant acid phosphatase.
  • In other cases, efficacy may be determined by the percent reduction in PTH relative to a pre-dosing (baseline) level and/or by achieving a desirable PTH level as generally accepted as being beneficial to patients (for example, guidelines established by the National Kidney Foundation). Still in other cases, efficacy may be determined by measurement of the reduction in parathyroid gland hyperplasia associated with a hyperparathyroidism disease.
  • It is expected that when a described method of treatment is administered to a subject in need thereof, the method of treatment will produce an effect, as measured by, for example, one or more of: total serum calcium, ionized serum calcium, total blood calcium, ionized blood calcium, albumin, plasma PTH, blood PTH, PTHrP, phosphate, vitamin D, magnesium, bone mineral density (BMD), total alkaline phosphatase, bone alkaline phosphatase, osteocalcin, under carboxylated osteocalcin, C-terminal procollagen type I propeptide, N-terminal procollagen type I propeptide, hydroxyproline, hydroxylysine, glycosyl-galactosyl hydroxylysine, galactosyl hydroxylysine, pyridinoline, deoxypyridinoline, N-terminal crosslinking telopeptide of type I collagen, C-terminal crosslinking telopeptide of type I collagen, C-terminal crosslinking telopeptide of type I collagen generated by MMPs, bone sialoprotein, acid phosphatase and tartrate-resistant acid phosphatase. Effects include prophylactic treatment as well as treatment of existing disease.
  • A biologically effective molecule may be operably linked to a described peptide with a covalent bond or a non-covalent interaction. In specific embodiments, the operably linked biologically effective molecules can alter the pharmacokinetics of the described compounds by virtue of conferring properties to the compound as part of a linked molecule. Some of the properties that the biologically effective molecules can confer on the described compounds include, but are not limited to: delivery of a compound to a discrete location within the body; concentrating the activity of a compound at a desired location in the body and reducing its effects elsewhere; reducing side effects of treatment with a compound; changing the permeability of a compound; changing the bioavailability or the rate of delivery to the body of a compound; changing the length of the effect of treatment with a compound; altering the in vitro chemical stability of the compound; altering the in vivo stability of the compound, half-life, clearance, absorption, distribution and/or excretion; altering the rate of the onset and the decay of the effects of a compound; providing a permissive action by allowing a compound to have an effect.
  • In a further aspect, the described compound may be conjugated to polyethylene glycol (PEG). The selected PEG may be of any convenient molecular weight, and may be linear or branched, and may be optionally conjugated through a linker. The average molecular weight of PEG will preferably range from about 2 kiloDalton (kDa) to about 100 kDa, more preferably from about 5 kDa to about 40 kDa. Alternatively, the PEG moiety used can be 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, or 20 kDa.
  • The described compounds may be conjugated to PEG through a suitable amino acid residue located at any position on the compounds. The described compounds may optionally contain an additional amino acid residue to which PEG is conjugated, including for example, an additional amine-containing residue, such as lysine.
  • PEGylated peptides are known in the art to increase serum half-life of conjugated peptide. A variety of methods are known in the art for the formation of PEGylated peptides. For example, the PEG moiety can be linked to the amino terminus, the carboxy terminus or through a side chain of the claimed peptide, optionally through the presence of a linking group. In other embodiments, the PEG moiety may be linked to the sulfur of a thiol-containing amino acid, such as cysteine, or may be coupled to the sidechain of an amine-containing amino acid, such as lysine.
  • The PEG groups will generally be attached to the described compound by acylation or alkylation through a reactive group on the PEG moiety (e.g., an aldehyde, amine, oxime, hydrazine thiol, ester, or carboxylic acid group) to a reactive group on the described compound (e.g., an aldehyde, amine, oxime, hydrazine, ester, acid or thiol group), which may be located at the amino terminus, carboxy terminus, or a sidechain position of the described compound. One approach for preparation of PEGylation of synthetic peptides consists of combining through a conjugate linkage in solution, a peptide and a PEG moiety, each bearing a functional group that is mutually reactive towards the other. Peptides can be easily prepared using conventional solution or solid phase synthesis techniques. Conjugation of the peptide and PEG is typically done in aqueous phase and may be monitored by reverse phase HPLC. The PEGylated peptides can be readily purified and characterized, using standard techniques known to one of skill in the art.
  • One or more individual subunits of the described compounds may also be modified with various derivatizing agents known to react with specific side chains or terminal residues. For example, lysinyl residues and amino terminal residues may be reacted with succinic anhydride or other similar carboxylic acid anhydrides which reverses the charge on the lysinyl or amino residue. Other suitable reagents include, e.g., imidoesters such as methyl picolinimidate; pyridoxal; pyridoxal phosphate; chloroborohydride; trinitrobenzenesulfonic acid; O-methylisourea, 2,4,-pentanedione; and transaminase-catalyzed reaction with glyoxalate. Arginyl residues may be modified by reaction with conventional agents such as phenylglyoxal, 2,3-butanedione, 1,2-cyclohexanedione, and ninhydrin.
  • In addition, the described compounds may be modified to include non-cationic residues that provide immunogenic residues useful for the development of antibodies for bioanalytical ELISA measurements, as well as to evaluate immunogenicity. For example, the described compounds may be modified by incorporation of tyrosine and/or glycine residues. Specific modifications of tyrosyl residues are of particular interest for introducing spectral labels into tyrosyl residues. Non-limiting examples include reaction with aromatic diazonium compounds or tetranitromethane. Most commonly, N-acetylimidazole and tetranitromethane are used to form O-acetyl tyrosyl and 3-nitro derivatives, respectively.
  • Kits Comprising the Disclosed Compounds
  • The invention also provides kits for carrying out the therapeutic regimens of the invention. Such kits comprise therapeutically effective amounts of the described compounds having activity as a CaSR modulator, in pharmaceutically acceptable form, alone or in combination with other agents, in pharmaceutically acceptable form. Preferred pharmaceutical forms include the described compounds in combination with sterile saline, dextrose solution, buffered solution, sterile water, or other pharmaceutically acceptable sterile fluid. Alternatively the composition may include an antimicrobial or bacteriostatic agent. Alternatively, the composition may be lyophilized or desiccated. In this instance, the kit may further comprise a pharmaceutically acceptable solution, preferably sterile, to form a solution for injection purposes. In another embodiment, the kit may further comprise a needle or syringe, preferably packaged in sterile form, for injecting the composition. In other embodiments, the kit further comprises an instruction means for administering the composition to a subject. The instruction means can be a written insert, an audiotape, an audiovisual tape, or any other means of instructing the administration of the composition to a subject.
  • In one embodiment, the kit comprises (i) a first container containing a described compound having activity as a CaSR modulator; and (ii) instruction means for use. In another embodiment the kit comprises (i) a first container containing a compound as described herein, and (ii) a second container containing a pharmaceutically acceptable vehicle for dilution or reconstitution.
  • In another embodiment, the kit comprises (i) a first container containing a described compound having activity as a CaSR modulator; (ii) a second container containing an anticalcemic agent; and (iii) instruction means for use.
  • In one embodiment, the anticalcemic agent is and agent selected from the group consisting of bisphosphonate agents, hormone replacement therapeutic agents, vitamin D therapy, vitamin D analogs, such as ZEMPLAR™ (paricalcitol); CALCIJEX® (calcitriol), ONE-ALPHA® (alfacalcidol) and HECTOROL® (doxercalciferol), low dose PTH (with or without estrogen), and calcitonin.
  • In related aspects, the invention provides articles of manufacture that comprise the contents of the kits described above. For instance, the invention provides an article of manufacture comprising an effective amount of a described peptide, alone or in combination with other agents, and instruction means indicating use for treating diseases described herein.
  • EXAMPLES
  • The following examples are offered to illustrate but not to limit the compounds and methods described herein. Various modifications may be made by the skilled person without departing from the true spirit and scope of the subject matter described herein.
  • Example 1 Cationic Compounds with PTH Lowering Activity A. Model of Renal Insufficiency
  • A rat model of acute renal insufficiency (also referred to as the 1K1C model) was developed to simulate the pathology of SHPT associated with end stage renal disease. The model exhibits pathological characteristics of hyper parathyroidsm associated with a lack of renal function, specifically the significant elevation of plasma PTH and reduction in serum calcium. The development of this model allowed for the further characterization of described compounds in the context of a subject with renal dysfunction and elevated PTH. Typical baseline PTH levels in this model averaged ˜450 μg/mL.
  • The 1K1C model of acute renal insufficiency involves the removal of one kidney followed by exposure of the remaining kidney to 45 minutes of ischemia and 48 hours of reperfusion. The ensuing ischemia/reperfusion (I/R) damage to the remaining kidney results in significant necrosis and renal failure. Serum creatinine levels were elevated for over 24-48 hours following I/R insult (data not shown). Also due to the resulting renal dysfunction, total PTH levels are dramatically increased from the pre-I/R injury levels of ˜100 μg/mL. By 48 hours post-I/R, plasma PTH levels were elevated to ˜450 μg/mL (˜5 fold increase) and in some instances reach as high as ˜1200 μg/mL. This reproducible increase in serum creatinine and PTH provided a robust model that mimics the physiology seen ESRD patients.
  • Cinacalcet hydrochloride (SENSIPAR®), an approved calcimimetic agent that is used to lower PTH for the treatment of SHPT, was tested in the 1K1C model of acute renal insufficiency. Oral administration of cinacalcet at 30 mg/kg significantly lowered PTH by approximately 50% for up to 6 hours. This result is consistent with the published preclinical data for cinacalcet (Nemeth et al., J. Pharmacol. Exp. Ther., 308(2):627-35 (2004)) and validates that the 1K1C model of acute renal insufficiency is an appropriate model for evaluating the activity of calcimimetics for this indication.
  • The protocol used in this study is as follows. Male Sprague Dawley rats were purchased from Charles River Laboratories (Hollister, Calif.; requested purchase weight 250-275 g). For studies with test articles, animals were pre-cannulated in the femoral and jugular veins for drug administration and blood draws, respectively. Animals were maintained in a temperature-controlled environment with a constant 12 hours light/12 hours dark cycle and free access to food and water at all times. All experimental procedures with animals were performed according to IACUC guidelines.
  • General anesthesia was induced and maintained by intraperitoneal (IP) injection of sodium pentobarbital (5.2%, 0.4 mL/rat). For animals that received 45 minutes of renal ischemia an additional IP injection of sodium pentobarbital (5.2%, 0.1 mL/rat) was given to maintain the anesthetic plane. Blood sampling for PTH measurements following administration of compounds in normal rats was done under continuous isoflurane anesthesia.
  • A clean, aseptic technique was used for the entire procedure. After rats were anesthetized, the abdomen was shaved with electric clippers prior to the operation and the skin cleaned with 70% alcohol solution.
  • For model development studies, the left femoral vein was cannulated with a PE-10 tube for blood drawing. Both kidneys were exposed via a laparotomy. A right nephrectomy was performed after the right renal pedicle and ureter were ligated with double 2-0 silk sutures. After confirmation of non-bleeding in the right pedicle, the left renal artery was carefully dissected and clamped with a micro vascular clip to induce left renal global ischemia. Renal ischemia was confirmed by observation of a global white-grey color change (blanching). The abdominal incision was temporarily covered with gauze to help maintain the temperature of the abdominal organs. After 45 minutes, the designated period of ischemia, the clip was removed and left renal artery flow was considered restored upon observation of a global restoration of red color. The abdominal incision was closed in layers with 2-0 silk sutures. The animal was then recovered from anesthesia. Physiological parameters including body temperature (36-37.5° C.) and body weight were measured throughout the procedure. Body temperature was monitored and maintained using a heat pad rectal probe feedback system.
  • Approximately 48 hours after the 1K1C surgery (I/R injury), animals were dosed with various compounds to measure effects on plasma PTH and calcium. In most cases, test articles were administered by IV infusion ( infusion time 5, 10 or 30 minutes) although in some studies compounds were administered by IV bolus or subcutaneous (SC) bolus injection. For drug administration and blood draws, animals were anesthetized with isoflurane.
  • Blood samples were collected periodically throughout the course of the study. Serum samples were analyzed for of calcium levels and plasma samples were analyzed for PTH. Due to the range of baseline PTH values for individual rats, all data are normalized to pre-dosing (baseline) levels. Serum creatinine was measured using a commercially available kit from BioAssay Systems (Hayward, Ca), catalog #DICT-500. Analyses were performed according to the manufacturer's instructions.
  • B. Testing Compounds in Renal Insufficiency Model
  • Compounds with the following sequences were prepared for testing in the renal insufficiency model: Ac-crrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:4), n=4, Ac-crrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:5), n=4, Ac-crrrrrr-NH2(SEQ ID NO:6), n=7, Ac-crrrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:7), n=4, and saline control, n=2. The peptides were administered to animals at a dose of 3 mg/kg by a 30-minute IV infusion. Prior to dosing a blood sample was drawn to determine baseline, pre-dosing PTH plasma concentration. Results are shown in FIG. 1 as follows: Ac-crrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:4, diamonds), Ac-crrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:5, squares), Ac-crrrrrr-NH2(SEQ ID NO:6, triangles), and Ac-crrrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:7, open squares).
  • Example 2 In Vitro Cell Assay in HEK-293 Expressing the Human Calcium-Sensing Receptor
  • Human embryonic kidney (HEK) 293T cells were seeded into a T25 flask at 2 million cells per flask and allowed to incubate at 37° C. in 5% CO2 overnight. The day after, these cells were transfected with human CaSR receptor using lipofectamine 2000 transfection reagent 24 hrs post transfection, cells were seeded in 384 well plates at 8,000 cells/well. Assays were carried out 48 hours after the transfection. In some cases, EC50 values were determined by measuring inositol monophosphate production in the HEK293 cells, stably transfected with the human calcium-sensing receptor (see Table 1).
  • The cell culture medium was aspirated from the wells and replaced with 28 μL of 1× stimulation buffer (Hepes 10 mM, CaCl2) 1 mM, MgCl2 0.5 mM, KCl 4.2 mM, NaCl 146 mM, glucose 5.5 mM, LiCl 50 mM pH 7.4). Cells were incubated with compounds at various concentrations (1 mM or 300 μM as the highest and further ½ log serial dilutions) at 37° C. for 1.5 hrs before reaction termination. IP1 production was determined in cells using the Cisbio IP-One Tb kit (621PAPEC) and according to manufacturer instructions. In brief, incubation with the compound was terminated by sequentially adding D2 labeled-IP1 and cryptate-labeled anti-IP1 in lysis buffer and further incubating at room temperature for 60 minutes. Plates were read at 620 nm and 668 nm with 314 nm excitation. Non-transfected 293 cells were used as negative control.
  • The ratio of fluorescence at 668 nm and 620 nm was determined. IP1 concentrations were calculated from standard curves (generated with Graph Pad Prism ver. 4) using known concentrations of IP1 standards. EC50s were calculated based on the values of the fluorescent ratio OD(668 nm)/(OD620 nm) using non-linear regression curve fitting in Prism software.
  • Peptides and conjugates were prepared by solid-phase chemistry at 0.25 mmol scale on an ABI automated synthesizer. Sequential coupling of Fmoc-amino acids (4 eq, Anaspec) to Rink-amide resin (NovaBiochem) was accomplished using HBTU/DIEA activation. The assembled peptide was cleaved with a TFA cocktail (phenol (5%), triisopropylsilane (2.5%) and water (2.5%); 10 mL per gram of resin) and isolated by precipitation with diethyl ether. After purification by C18 HPLC the final product was isolated in the TFA salt form by lyophilization of appropriate fractions, and characterized by HPLC (>95% purity) and LC-MS (confirmed MVV).
  • Example 3 In Vivo Administration of Compounds with Cationic Subunits
  • The peptides were administered intravenously at a dose of 0.5 mg/kg into isoflurane-anesthetized normal Sprague Dawley rats. A control group of rats was treated with saline. Blood was drawn prior to dosing and every hour for 4 hours. Rats were maintained under isoflurane anesthesia for the entire study. The concentration of PTH in the plasma was measured by ELISA, detecting the bioactive intact PTH 1-84 (Immutopics International catalog number 60-2700), and the cumulative area under the curve for AUC was calculated for the data points inclusive of 1-4 hours. Percent PTH reduction was calculated according to the following formula: AUCcmpd treated/AUCsaline control*100.
  • Example 4 Structure-Activity Relationship Studies: In Vivo Activity
  • The peptides tested identified herein as SEQ ID NO: 26 (Ac-carrrar-NH2) and as SEQ ID NO:29 (Ac-arrrar-NH2) were tested in vitro using the HEK293 CaSR transfected cells, according to the procedure in Example 2. The peptides were also tested in vivo, by administering as an IV bolus to normal Sprague Dawley rats at doses of 9 mg/kg for SEQ ID NO:29 and at 0.5 mg/kg for SEQ ID NO: 26. An intravenous (IV) bolus of saline was used as a control. Plasma (K2EDTA) PTH levels were assessed prior to dosing and 1, 2, 3 and 4 hours after dosing. Rats were maintained under isoflurane anesthesia for the entire study. The results are shown in FIGS. 2A-2B, presented as group average±standard deviation (SD). In FIG. 2B, PTH is shown as percent of the baseline pre-dose value.
  • Example 5 Structure-Activity Relationship Studies: D- and L-Amino Acid Subunits
  • A series of compounds having an L-amino acid residue substituted for a D-amino acid residue were prepared. The compounds were administered as an IV bolus to normal Sprague Dawley rats at a dose of 0.5 mg/kg. An intravenous (IV) bolus of saline was used as a control. Plasma (K2EDTA) PTH levels were assessed prior to dosing and 1, 2, 3 and 4 hours after dosing, and the AUC was calculated as described above. Rats were maintained under isoflurane anesthesia for the entire study. The results are shown in Table 4 above.
  • Example 6 Structure-Activity Relationship Studies: Histamine Release
  • To evaluate the effect of net positive charge on the histamine release associated with a compound, peptides containing 4 to 7 cationic (arginine) residues were generated and tested for their ability to trigger histamine release in vivo. The tested peptides included (i) Ac-crrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:4), (ii) Ac-crrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:5), (iii) Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:6) and (iv) Ac-crrrrrrrr-NH2; SEQ ID NO:41).
  • Male Sprague-Dawley rats were obtained (Charles River) pre-cannulated in the femoral and jugular veins for drug infusion and blood draws, respectively. All IV drug treatments were conducted under anesthetic (isoflurane). Animals were dosed by a 1-minute IV push in a total volume of 0.5 mL. Blood samples were taken at 5, 15 and 30 minutes following IV bolus to generate plasma (K2EDTA) samples for histamine analysis. For 30 minute IV infusion studies, sample was taken at the end of infusion. In some case rats in the 1K1C model of acute renal ischemia were used.
  • An equal volume of saline was injected following each blood draw to replace lost volume. Approximately 0.2 mL of blood was withdrawn at each time point using pre-coated EDTA syringes to facilitate serum collection.
  • Histamine ELISAs were performed on diluted plasma using the Histamine Enzyme Immunoassay (EIA) kit (Cat #A05890, SPI-BIO, Montigny le Bretonneux, France). The Histamine EIA kit is a derivitization-amplified competitive enzyme immunoassay which detects histamine within the range of 40 μg/mL to 5,500 μg/mL. The samples were analyzed in duplicate according to the manufacturer's protocol.
  • Lyophilized peptides (TFA salts) were weighed and the recorded mass was adjusted for peptide content. Solutions were prepared by dissolving the material in normal saline to generate the desired peptide concentration. In some cases the molarity of peptide was adjusted to allow for inter-peptide comparison. The peptides were administered by IV bolus at an equivalent dose on a per mole basis as SEQ ID NO:41 (i.e., 0.7 μmole/rat) by a 1-minute IV bolus and plasma histamine was measured before dosing (pre-dose), 5, 15 and 30 minutes after dosing. Data are presented as group averages (n=2)±SD. Histamine release is shown as fold change from pre-dose (baseline) levels. Results are shown in FIG. 3. Data are presented as group averages (n=2)±SD.
  • Example 7 Structure-Activity Relationship Studies: Histamine Release
  • For in vitro evaluation of histamine release, isolated rat peritoneal mast cells were isolated by performing peritoneal lavage using cold HBSS+25 mM HEPES pH 7.4 containing heparin (5 u/mL). Cells were washed twice in stimulation buffer (HBSS+25 mM HEPES pH 7.4) and incubated with 10 μM of compound in stimulation buffer (HBSS+25 mM HEPES pH 7.4) for 15 minutes in a 96-well plate (106/well) at 37° C. Cell supernatant was analyzed for histamine using histamine EIA kit (Cayman #589651). Data is shown in Table 10.
  • For the in vivo evaluation of histamine release, compounds were dosed in isoflurane-anesthetized normal rats at 2 mg/kg by IV bolus (administered over less than one minute). Plasma histamine was measured 5 minutes after compound administration (Cayman histamine EIA #589651). Data is shown in Table 11.
  • The abbreviations used herein, and in particular in Tables 10-11 are summarized here.
  • Ahx 6-aminohexanoic acid
    Aib 2-aminoisobutyric acid
    bAla beta-alanine (3-aminopropionic acid)
    dHcy D-homocysteine
    dNle D-norleucine
    dNva D-norvaline
    dPen D-penicillamine
    EG ethylene glycol spacer, H2N—(CH2CH2—O)4—CH2—CO2H
    Hcy homocysteine
    Mpa 3-mercaptopropionic acid or mercaptopropionic acid
    Nma N-methylalanine
    PEG poly (ethylene glycol)
    Sar Sarcosine (N-methylglycine)
    dHar D-homoarginine
    GS Glutatione (conjugated)
    DAP 1,3-diaminopropionic acid
  • Example 8 Structure-Activity Relationship Studies: In Vivo Activity
  • The compound Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:3) was prepared for comparison with the compound Ac-carrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:26). In the compound Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:3) the thiol-containing subunit in position X1 is conjugated via a disulfide linkage to an L-Cys residue. The two compounds were administered via IV bolus to animals with the 1K1C model of acute renal insufficiency at doses of 0.3 and 0.5 mg/kg. Plasma PTH levels were assessed prior to dosing and periodically for 24 hours after dosing. Results are shown in FIG. 10, where data shown are group averages±SEM, where as a function of time, in hours, in rats with 1K1C model of acute renal insufficiency, the compound Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:3) is represented by squares (0.3 mg/kg, n=5) and * symbols (0.5 mg/kg, n=6) and the compound Ac-c(Ac-C)arrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:141) by triangles (0.3 mg/kg, n=8) and diamonds (0.5 mg/kg, n=7).
  • Example 9 Micropore Facilitated Transdermal Delivery of Calcimimetic Agents
  • To evaluate systemic delivery of a calicimimetic agent, Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:6) was administered to CD hairless rats transdermally using a reservoir. Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:6) was applied as a 10% solution in saline to an approximately 1 cm2 area on the back of CD® hairless rats that were microporated by 5 passes of a 1.0 mm Derma Roller under moderate pressure. A polystyrene chamber (I.D. 9.5 mm) was glued over the microporated area of skin to create a drug reservoir in which the solution of either Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO: 6) or a saline solution were applied. A 10% solution of Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO: 6) was administered in the reservoir chamber on two rats, a saline solution alone was administered in the reservoir chamber on one rat. The reservoirs were covered with tape to prevent evaporation. Blood draws were taken over a 4 hour period and plasma was analyzed for PTH levels by ELISA. The results are shown in FIG. 11.
  • Example 10 Sustained Delivery of Calcimimetic Agents by Micropore Facilitated Transdermal Patch
  • To further evaluate systemic delivery of a calcimimetic agent, Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:3) was administered transdermally to normal rats using a transdermal patch. Normal rats were treated with microneedle array and transdermal patch system. A small area of fur on the back of Sprague Dawley rats (˜350 g) was sheared using clippers and an area of skin was microporated using a 14×14 array (˜1 cm2) of microneedles (˜0.5 mm). A transdermal patch system containing 10% solution (by weight) of Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:3) in saline was placed over the microporated area and left in place for ˜30 hours. Blood draws were taken from the rats periodically over the 30 hours and plasma samples was analyzed for PTH levels by ELISA. The results are shown in FIG. 12.
  • Example 11 Infusion of Calcimimetic Agents
  • To further evaluate the PTH lowering effect of the calcimimetic compound Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO:3) was administered by very low dose IV infusion to normal rats and rats with renal insufficiency to identify the lowest dose needed to be administered by infusion, transdermal patch system or other sustained delivery means to achieve significant PTH reduction. Normal Sprague-Dawley male rats (250-300 g) were intravenously infused for 6 hours with Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO: 3) at dose rates of 1 μg/kg/hr, 3 μg/kg/hr, and 10 μg/kg/hr. Blood samples were taken prior to dosing, at 2 hours, 4 hours, 6 hours (just prior to the end of infusion; EOI) and 8 hours (2 hrs post EOI) and plasma was analyzed for PTH levels by ELISA. The data are shown in FIG. 13, where rats treated with 1 μg/kg/hr (squares), 3 μg/kg/hr (diamonds), and 10 μg/kg/hr (triangles) for 6 hours were effective to produce significant reduction in PTH from baseline over the course of infusion.
  • A similar study was conducted in rats with the 1K1C model of acute renal insufficiency. 1K1C model rats were intravenously infused with Ac-c(C)arrrar-NH2 (SEQ ID NO: 273 at dose rates of 30 μg/kg/hr and 100 μg/kg/hr for 6 hours. Blood samples were taken prior to dosing (Pre), at 2 hours, 4 hours, 6 hours (just prior to the end of infusion; EOI), 8 hours (2 hrs post EOI) and 24 hours and plasma was analyzed for PTH levels by ELISA. The data are shown in FIG. 14A (30 μg/kg/hr, diamonds, and 100 μg/kg/hr, squares) and the serum calcium for the animals is shown in FIG. 14B.

Claims (11)

We claim:
1. A compound comprising the formula:

X1-X2-X3-X4-X5-X6-X7
wherein
X1 is an amino acid comprising a thiol-containing group, D-penicillamine, d-homocysteine or mercaptopropionic acid;
X2, X3, X4, X5, X5, and X7 are each D-arginine.
2. The compound of claim 1, wherein X1 is an amino acid comprising a thiol-containing group is selected from L-cysteine and D-cysteine.
3. The compound of claim 1 or claim 2, wherein the compound is chemically modified at the N-terminus, the C-terminus or both.
4. The compound of any one of claims 1-3, wherein the N-terminus of the compound is acetylated and the C-terminus of the peptide is amidated.
5. The compound of any one of claims 1-4, wherein the compound is Ac-crrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO: 6).
6. The compound of any one of claims 1-4, wherein the compound is Ac-beta alanine-rrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO: 30).
7. The compound of any one of claims 1-4, wherein the compound is mercaptopropionic acid-rrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO: 31).
8. The compound of any one of claims 1-4, wherein the compound is Ac-d-homocysteine-rrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO: 32).
9. The compound of any one of claims 1-4, wherein the compound is Ac-D-penicillamin-rrrrrr-NH2 (SEQ ID NO: 33).
10. A composition comprising the compound of any one of claims 1-9 and a pharmaceutically acceptable excipient.
11. A composition comprising a compound according to any one of claim 10, for use in the treatment of a subject suffering from hyperparathyroidism or a hypercalcemic disorder.
US17/010,773 2009-07-29 2020-09-02 Therapeutic agents for reducing parathyroid hormone levels Abandoned US20200399309A1 (en)

Priority Applications (2)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US17/010,773 US20200399309A1 (en) 2009-07-29 2020-09-02 Therapeutic agents for reducing parathyroid hormone levels
US17/960,060 US20240116983A1 (en) 2009-07-29 2022-10-04 Therapeutic agents for reducing parathyroid hormone levels

Applications Claiming Priority (10)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US22969509P 2009-07-29 2009-07-29
US25581609P 2009-10-28 2009-10-28
US31363510P 2010-03-12 2010-03-12
US12/846,724 US8999932B2 (en) 2009-07-29 2010-07-29 Therapeutic agents for reducing parathyroid hormone levels
US13/365,213 US8377880B2 (en) 2009-07-29 2012-02-02 Therapeutic agents for reducing parathyroid hormone levels
US13/769,744 US9278995B2 (en) 2009-07-29 2013-02-18 Therapeutic agents for reducing parathyroid hormone levels
US15/018,567 US9701712B2 (en) 2009-07-29 2016-02-08 Therapeutic agents for reducing parathyroid hormone levels
US15/629,536 US10280198B2 (en) 2009-07-29 2017-06-21 Therapeutic agents for reducing parathyroid hormone levels
US16/298,902 US20190194252A1 (en) 2009-07-29 2019-03-11 Therapeutic agents for reducing parathyroid hormone levels
US17/010,773 US20200399309A1 (en) 2009-07-29 2020-09-02 Therapeutic agents for reducing parathyroid hormone levels

Related Parent Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US16/298,902 Continuation US20190194252A1 (en) 2009-07-29 2019-03-11 Therapeutic agents for reducing parathyroid hormone levels

Related Child Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US17/960,060 Continuation US20240116983A1 (en) 2009-07-29 2022-10-04 Therapeutic agents for reducing parathyroid hormone levels

Publications (1)

Publication Number Publication Date
US20200399309A1 true US20200399309A1 (en) 2020-12-24

Family

ID=43527590

Family Applications (10)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US12/846,724 Active 2032-01-13 US8999932B2 (en) 2009-07-29 2010-07-29 Therapeutic agents for reducing parathyroid hormone levels
US13/365,213 Active US8377880B2 (en) 2009-07-29 2012-02-02 Therapeutic agents for reducing parathyroid hormone levels
US13/769,744 Active 2030-10-12 US9278995B2 (en) 2009-07-29 2013-02-18 Therapeutic agents for reducing parathyroid hormone levels
US14/639,020 Active US9567370B2 (en) 2009-07-29 2015-03-04 Therapeutic agents for reducing parathyroid hormone levels
US15/018,567 Active US9701712B2 (en) 2009-07-29 2016-02-08 Therapeutic agents for reducing parathyroid hormone levels
US15/402,133 Abandoned US20170114095A1 (en) 2009-07-29 2017-01-09 Therapeutic agents for reducing parathyroid hormone levels
US15/629,536 Active US10280198B2 (en) 2009-07-29 2017-06-21 Therapeutic agents for reducing parathyroid hormone levels
US16/298,902 Abandoned US20190194252A1 (en) 2009-07-29 2019-03-11 Therapeutic agents for reducing parathyroid hormone levels
US17/010,773 Abandoned US20200399309A1 (en) 2009-07-29 2020-09-02 Therapeutic agents for reducing parathyroid hormone levels
US17/960,060 Pending US20240116983A1 (en) 2009-07-29 2022-10-04 Therapeutic agents for reducing parathyroid hormone levels

Family Applications Before (8)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US12/846,724 Active 2032-01-13 US8999932B2 (en) 2009-07-29 2010-07-29 Therapeutic agents for reducing parathyroid hormone levels
US13/365,213 Active US8377880B2 (en) 2009-07-29 2012-02-02 Therapeutic agents for reducing parathyroid hormone levels
US13/769,744 Active 2030-10-12 US9278995B2 (en) 2009-07-29 2013-02-18 Therapeutic agents for reducing parathyroid hormone levels
US14/639,020 Active US9567370B2 (en) 2009-07-29 2015-03-04 Therapeutic agents for reducing parathyroid hormone levels
US15/018,567 Active US9701712B2 (en) 2009-07-29 2016-02-08 Therapeutic agents for reducing parathyroid hormone levels
US15/402,133 Abandoned US20170114095A1 (en) 2009-07-29 2017-01-09 Therapeutic agents for reducing parathyroid hormone levels
US15/629,536 Active US10280198B2 (en) 2009-07-29 2017-06-21 Therapeutic agents for reducing parathyroid hormone levels
US16/298,902 Abandoned US20190194252A1 (en) 2009-07-29 2019-03-11 Therapeutic agents for reducing parathyroid hormone levels

Family Applications After (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US17/960,060 Pending US20240116983A1 (en) 2009-07-29 2022-10-04 Therapeutic agents for reducing parathyroid hormone levels

Country Status (30)

Country Link
US (10) US8999932B2 (en)
EP (5) EP3808363B1 (en)
JP (3) JP5270799B2 (en)
KR (1) KR101781841B1 (en)
CN (2) CN107674114B (en)
AU (1) AU2010278897B2 (en)
BR (1) BR112012002143B8 (en)
CA (1) CA2769525C (en)
CY (3) CY1118388T1 (en)
DK (2) DK2459208T3 (en)
ES (2) ES2607954T3 (en)
FR (1) FR17C1009I2 (en)
HK (1) HK1167108A1 (en)
HR (2) HRP20161614T1 (en)
HU (3) HUE030960T2 (en)
IL (1) IL217749A (en)
LT (3) LT2459208T (en)
LU (1) LUC00008I2 (en)
MX (1) MX2012001213A (en)
NO (1) NO2017021I1 (en)
NZ (1) NZ597922A (en)
PL (2) PL3192520T3 (en)
PT (2) PT3192520T (en)
RU (1) RU2557654C3 (en)
SG (2) SG178143A1 (en)
SI (2) SI3192520T1 (en)
SM (1) SMT201700014B (en)
TW (1) TWI520744B (en)
WO (1) WO2011014707A2 (en)
ZA (1) ZA201200726B (en)

Families Citing this family (31)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US8987200B2 (en) * 2006-11-16 2015-03-24 Kai Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Polycationic calcium modulator peptides for the treatment of hyperparathyroidism and hypercalcemic disorders
CA2769525C (en) 2009-07-29 2017-02-21 Kai Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Therapeutic agents for reducing parathyroid hormone levels
JP5761173B2 (en) 2010-03-04 2015-08-12 味の素株式会社 Preventive or therapeutic agent for diabetes or obesity
KR101493717B1 (en) 2010-03-04 2015-02-16 아지노모토 가부시키가이샤 Alkylamine derivative
JP5796570B2 (en) 2010-03-24 2015-10-21 味の素株式会社 Glutamic acid ester derivative or salt thereof
WO2011126099A1 (en) 2010-04-02 2011-10-13 味の素株式会社 Prophylactic agent or therapeutic agent for diabetes or obesity
DK2717896T3 (en) * 2011-06-08 2016-12-19 Kai Pharmaceuticals Inc Therapeutics for regulating phoshor serum
EP2776129B2 (en) * 2011-11-10 2020-06-17 Kai Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Compositions for use in the treatment of chronic kidney disease-mineral bone disorder characterized by soft tissue calcification
WO2013158739A1 (en) * 2012-04-17 2013-10-24 Brown University Neuroprotective composition and method of use
US20200354428A9 (en) 2013-06-23 2020-11-12 Wisconsin Alumni Research Foundation Analogues of parathyroid hormone (1-34) that function as agonists of the parathyroid hormone receptor-1 and display modified activity profiles
SG11201510647TA (en) * 2013-06-28 2016-01-28 Amgen Inc Stable liquid formulation of amg 416 (velcalcetide)
RS60187B1 (en) 2014-04-03 2020-06-30 Amgen Inc Method for preparing amg 416
CN105504012A (en) * 2014-09-30 2016-04-20 深圳翰宇药业股份有限公司 Preparation method of polypeptide
CA2964463C (en) 2014-10-22 2024-02-13 Extend Biosciences, Inc. Therapeutic vitamin d conjugates
US9616109B2 (en) 2014-10-22 2017-04-11 Extend Biosciences, Inc. Insulin vitamin D conjugates
CA2980960C (en) 2015-03-26 2024-05-28 Amgen Inc. Solution phase method for preparing etelcalcetide
US9336841B1 (en) * 2015-04-16 2016-05-10 Taiwan Semiconductor Manufacturing Co., Ltd. Pipeline register with data alignment therein
CN106928320B (en) 2015-12-31 2021-01-15 深圳翰宇药业股份有限公司 Method for synthesizing Etelcalcetide
CN106928321B (en) * 2015-12-31 2019-07-26 深圳翰宇药业股份有限公司 A method of synthesis Etelcalcetide
US10105375B2 (en) 2016-08-30 2018-10-23 Wisconsin Alumni Research Foundation Combination of low dose 2-methylene-19-nor-(20S)1α, 25-dihydroxyvitamin D3 and calcimimetics to treat secondary hyperparathyroidism
CN111601614A (en) * 2017-11-07 2020-08-28 阿尔法科制药有限责任公司 Method for treating and preventing heart disease, cardiovascular disease and related diseases and symptoms
KR20200100676A (en) 2017-12-20 2020-08-26 이에이 파마 가부시키가이샤 Pharmaceutical composition for preventing or treating secondary hyperparathyroidism under maintenance dialysis
KR101933685B1 (en) * 2018-06-29 2018-12-28 주식회사 에스알바이오텍 Drug Coated Microneedle and Manufacturing Method Thereof
KR20210124958A (en) * 2018-11-02 2021-10-15 앰퍼샌드 바이오파마슈티컬스, 인코포레이티드 Formulations and Methods for Risk Potential Management of Cation Overload and Electrolyte Imbalance Using Topically Applied Buffers (BUFFERS)
US20220142958A1 (en) 2019-04-03 2022-05-12 Ea Pharma Co., Ltd. Medicinal composition having excellent stability
BR112022011127A2 (en) * 2019-12-09 2022-08-23 Beijing Tuo Jie Biopharmaceutical Co Ltd CALCIUM DETECTION RECEPTOR AGONIST COMPOUND AND APPLICATION THEREOF
WO2021226064A1 (en) * 2020-05-04 2021-11-11 University Of Louisville Research Foundation, Inc. Artificial intelligence-based systems and methods for dosing of pharmacologic agents
CA3194729A1 (en) * 2020-09-10 2022-03-17 Shaanxi Micot Technology Co., Ltd. Bispecific fusion polypeptide compound
US11359134B2 (en) 2020-10-19 2022-06-14 Saudi Arabian Oil Company Treatment fluids and methods for recovering hydrocarbons from a subterranean formation
TW202313655A (en) * 2021-06-08 2023-04-01 大陸商北京拓界生物醫藥科技有限公司 Hydrochloride of calcium-sensing receptor agonist compounds, pharmaceutical compositions and applications thereof
EP4353248A4 (en) * 2021-06-08 2024-10-23 Beijing Tuo Jie Biopharmaceutical Co Ltd Calcium-sensing receptor agonist composition and application thereof

Family Cites Families (54)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US5869473A (en) 1988-08-02 1999-02-09 Bone Care International, Inc. Method for treating and preventing hyperparathyroidism
US5602116A (en) 1988-08-02 1997-02-11 Bone Care International, Inc. Method for treating and preventing secondary hyperparathyroidism
US5246925A (en) 1989-03-09 1993-09-21 Wisconsin Alumni Research Foundation 19-nor-vitamin D compounds for use in treating hyperparathyroidism
CA1333616C (en) * 1989-03-09 1994-12-20 Hector F. Deluca 19-nor-vitamin d compounds
US5304121A (en) 1990-12-28 1994-04-19 Boston Scientific Corporation Drug delivery system making use of a hydrogel polymer coating
WO1992008476A1 (en) 1990-11-07 1992-05-29 The Scripps Research Institute Peptides that inhibit platelet binding of adhesion molecules
US6031003A (en) * 1991-08-23 2000-02-29 Nps Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Calcium receptor-active molecules
US5814603A (en) * 1992-06-12 1998-09-29 Affymax Technologies N.V. Compounds with PTH activity
US5716981A (en) 1993-07-19 1998-02-10 Angiogenesis Technologies, Inc. Anti-angiogenic compositions and methods of use
CA2145214A1 (en) 1995-02-28 1996-08-29 Rick E. Preddie Agents for pre-symptomatic diagnosis, prevention and cure huntington's disease (hd) in humans
US6099562A (en) 1996-06-13 2000-08-08 Schneider (Usa) Inc. Drug coating with topcoat
US5688489A (en) * 1995-09-15 1997-11-18 Resolution Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Non-receptor mediated imaging agents
ES2248853T3 (en) 1996-07-31 2006-03-16 The General Hospital Corporation NEW ANALOGS OF THE PEPTIDE RELATED TO THE PARTIROID HORMONE.
US5895368A (en) * 1996-09-23 1999-04-20 Medisystems Technology Corporation Blood set priming method and apparatus
WO1998017299A1 (en) * 1996-10-18 1998-04-30 The Board Of Trustees Of The Leland Stanford Junior University Isozyme-specific activators of protein kinase c, methods and compositions
US5955431A (en) 1997-02-05 1999-09-21 Brigham And Women's Hospital, Inc. Mast cell protease peptide inhibitors
IL132901A0 (en) 1997-05-14 2001-03-19 Aventis Pharm Prod Inc Peptide parathyroid hormone analogs
AU734827B2 (en) * 1997-05-21 2001-06-21 Board Of Trustees Of The Leland Stanford Junior University Composition and method for enhancing transport across biological membranes
US6258774B1 (en) 1998-03-19 2001-07-10 University Of Medicine And Dentistry Of New Jersey Carrier for in vivo delivery of a therapeutic agent
US7399489B2 (en) 1999-01-14 2008-07-15 Amylin Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Exendin analog formulations
JP2000336099A (en) * 1999-05-27 2000-12-05 Sekisui Chem Co Ltd Peptide and reagent for detecting hepatitis c antibody
US6274169B1 (en) 1999-08-02 2001-08-14 Abbott Laboratories Low oxygen content compostions of 1α, 25-dihydroxycholecalciferol
US6051567A (en) * 1999-08-02 2000-04-18 Abbott Laboratories Low oxygen content compositions of 1α, 25-dihydroxycholecalciferol
US20020068342A1 (en) * 2000-02-09 2002-06-06 Rami Khosravi Novel nucleic acid and amino acid sequences and novel variants of alternative splicing
IL153378A0 (en) 2000-07-18 2003-07-06 Bone Care Internat Inc STABILIZED 1alpha-HYDROXY VITAMIN D
DE10041126A1 (en) * 2000-08-22 2002-04-04 Aventis Res & Tech Gmbh & Co DNA binding peptide domains and a method for providing such domains
US20080249016A1 (en) * 2000-09-18 2008-10-09 Sanos Bioscience A/S Use of GLP-2 in a combination treatment for bone-related disorders
US20020168354A1 (en) * 2000-11-10 2002-11-14 Daria Mochly-Rosen psiepsilonRack peptide composition and method for protection against tissue damage due to ischemia
EP2338899A1 (en) * 2001-01-18 2011-06-29 The Board Of Trustees Of The Leland Stanford Junior University Peptides for activation and inhibition of delta PKC
US20030091640A1 (en) 2001-02-08 2003-05-15 Srinivasan Ramanathan Enhanced oral and transcompartmental delivery of therapeutic or diagnostic agents
US20030036627A1 (en) * 2001-02-16 2003-02-20 Montelaro Ronald C. Virus derived antimicrobial peptides
AU2002247724B2 (en) 2001-02-23 2008-02-07 Polyphor Ltd. Template-fixed peptidomimetics with antimicrobial activity
WO2003014078A2 (en) * 2001-08-08 2003-02-20 The Research Foundation Of The State University Of New York Muc7d1 peptides as antifungal and antibacterial agents
US6998404B2 (en) 2001-08-08 2006-02-14 Genomed, Llc Treatment or prevention of acute renal failure
US7060023B2 (en) 2001-09-25 2006-06-13 The Foundry Inc. Pericardium reinforcing devices and methods of using them
US7037897B2 (en) * 2001-10-31 2006-05-02 Abbott Laboratories TRI-, TETRA-, and penta-peptides having antiangiogenic activity
JP2005287302A (en) 2002-04-03 2005-10-20 Haruhiko Fujiwara Method for crosslinking polypeptide
AU2003299496A1 (en) * 2002-05-14 2004-05-25 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Polynucleotide encoding novel human g-protein coupled receptors, and splice variants thereof
DE602004009818T2 (en) 2003-11-05 2008-09-18 Intercell Ag COMPOSITIONS DERIVED FROM MELITTIN AND CONTAINING PEPTIDES, AND METHOD FOR POTENTIATING IMMUNE REACTIONS AGAINST TARGET ANTIGENES
CA2549052A1 (en) 2003-12-11 2005-06-30 The Board Of Trustees Of The Leland Stanford Junior University Isozyme-specific antagonists of protein kinase c
US7939634B2 (en) 2004-01-27 2011-05-10 Compugen Ltd. Polynucleotides encoding polypeptides and methods using same
US20060052303A1 (en) * 2004-07-27 2006-03-09 Sampath Kuber T Use of thyrotropin for regeneration of bone
US7265092B2 (en) * 2004-09-30 2007-09-04 Kai Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Pharmaceutical formulation
DE102005013846A1 (en) 2005-03-24 2006-10-05 Ganymed Pharmaceuticals Ag Identification of surface-associated antigens for tumor diagnosis and therapy
KR100687932B1 (en) * 2005-08-09 2007-02-27 삼성전자주식회사 Video display apparatus and video display method
JP2009511426A (en) * 2005-08-30 2009-03-19 アコロジックス インコーポレイティッド Regulation of mineral and skeletal metabolism
US8987200B2 (en) * 2006-11-16 2015-03-24 Kai Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Polycationic calcium modulator peptides for the treatment of hyperparathyroidism and hypercalcemic disorders
EP3248985B1 (en) 2007-01-19 2019-10-23 Kai Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Modifications of peptide compositions to increase stability and delivery efficiency
WO2009046220A2 (en) * 2007-10-02 2009-04-09 Mdrna, Inc. Lipopeptides for delivery of nucleic acids
WO2009075773A2 (en) 2007-12-07 2009-06-18 Goldstein Steven A Identification of toxin ligands
US20090318351A1 (en) * 2008-03-12 2009-12-24 Kevin Grimes Method of treating acute st-elevation myocardial infarction with a delta pkc antagonist
CA2769525C (en) 2009-07-29 2017-02-21 Kai Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Therapeutic agents for reducing parathyroid hormone levels
DK2717896T3 (en) * 2011-06-08 2016-12-19 Kai Pharmaceuticals Inc Therapeutics for regulating phoshor serum
EP2776129B2 (en) 2011-11-10 2020-06-17 Kai Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Compositions for use in the treatment of chronic kidney disease-mineral bone disorder characterized by soft tissue calcification

Also Published As

Publication number Publication date
IL217749A (en) 2016-09-29
ES2729051T3 (en) 2019-10-30
US20120178688A1 (en) 2012-07-12
SG178143A1 (en) 2012-03-29
PL3192520T3 (en) 2019-08-30
SI2459208T1 (en) 2017-04-26
EP4154900A1 (en) 2023-03-29
US20160159860A1 (en) 2016-06-09
LUC00008I2 (en) 2017-05-30
US9701712B2 (en) 2017-07-11
HK1167108A1 (en) 2012-11-23
LTPA2017007I1 (en) 2017-03-27
FR17C1009I2 (en) 2019-04-12
WO2011014707A2 (en) 2011-02-03
LUC00008I1 (en) 2017-03-16
HUS1700008I1 (en) 2017-04-28
ZA201200726B (en) 2013-05-29
HUE030960T2 (en) 2017-06-28
LT2459208T (en) 2017-02-27
US20130150297A1 (en) 2013-06-13
JP2013155195A (en) 2013-08-15
CY1118388T1 (en) 2017-06-28
EP2459208A2 (en) 2012-06-06
US20110028394A1 (en) 2011-02-03
DK3192520T3 (en) 2019-05-27
FR17C1009I1 (en) 2017-04-21
JP2014094967A (en) 2014-05-22
EP3808363B1 (en) 2022-09-07
HRP20190923T1 (en) 2019-10-04
CA2769525A1 (en) 2011-02-03
US20170114095A1 (en) 2017-04-27
US20180022777A1 (en) 2018-01-25
US20150175664A1 (en) 2015-06-25
JP2013500990A (en) 2013-01-10
CY1121922T1 (en) 2020-10-14
PL2459208T3 (en) 2017-05-31
US9567370B2 (en) 2017-02-14
NO2017021I1 (en) 2017-05-05
TW201116290A (en) 2011-05-16
LTC2459208I2 (en) 2021-07-12
EP3539555B1 (en) 2020-12-30
EP3192520A1 (en) 2017-07-19
EP2459208B1 (en) 2016-09-28
ES2607954T3 (en) 2017-04-04
EP4154900B1 (en) 2024-08-28
KR20120104513A (en) 2012-09-21
WO2011014707A3 (en) 2011-07-07
RU2012107428A (en) 2013-09-10
BR112012002143B1 (en) 2020-12-08
IL217749A0 (en) 2012-03-29
US9278995B2 (en) 2016-03-08
KR101781841B1 (en) 2017-09-26
LT3192520T (en) 2019-06-25
EP3808363A1 (en) 2021-04-21
SMT201700014B (en) 2017-03-08
DK2459208T3 (en) 2017-01-23
US10280198B2 (en) 2019-05-07
RU2557654C3 (en) 2017-07-05
HUE043838T2 (en) 2019-09-30
BR112012002143B8 (en) 2021-05-25
HRP20161614T1 (en) 2017-02-24
CA2769525C (en) 2017-02-21
US20240116983A1 (en) 2024-04-11
BR112012002143A2 (en) 2016-11-08
CN102711789B (en) 2018-06-08
EP2459208A4 (en) 2014-06-04
CY2017010I1 (en) 2017-11-14
US8377880B2 (en) 2013-02-19
CN107674114A (en) 2018-02-09
PT2459208T (en) 2017-01-03
AU2010278897A1 (en) 2012-02-23
AU2010278897B2 (en) 2015-02-26
TWI520744B (en) 2016-02-11
MX2012001213A (en) 2012-06-12
EP3192520B1 (en) 2019-03-06
SI3192520T1 (en) 2019-08-30
US8999932B2 (en) 2015-04-07
CY2017010I2 (en) 2017-11-14
PT3192520T (en) 2019-06-12
CN107674114B (en) 2022-10-25
EP3539555A1 (en) 2019-09-18
RU2557654C2 (en) 2015-07-27
CN102711789A (en) 2012-10-03
JP5270799B2 (en) 2013-08-21
NZ597922A (en) 2015-01-30
JP5764613B2 (en) 2015-08-19
SG10201406921SA (en) 2014-11-27
US20190194252A1 (en) 2019-06-27

Similar Documents

Publication Publication Date Title
US20240116983A1 (en) Therapeutic agents for reducing parathyroid hormone levels
US20170252397A1 (en) Calcimimetics and methods for their use

Legal Events

Date Code Title Description
STPP Information on status: patent application and granting procedure in general

Free format text: APPLICATION DISPATCHED FROM PREEXAM, NOT YET DOCKETED

AS Assignment

Owner name: KAI PHARMACEUTICALS, INC., CALIFORNIA

Free format text: ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST;ASSIGNORS:KARIM, FELIX;BARUCH, AMOS;DAS, KANAD;AND OTHERS;SIGNING DATES FROM 20101210 TO 20110422;REEL/FRAME:056103/0576

STPP Information on status: patent application and granting procedure in general

Free format text: DOCKETED NEW CASE - READY FOR EXAMINATION

STPP Information on status: patent application and granting procedure in general

Free format text: NON FINAL ACTION MAILED

STPP Information on status: patent application and granting procedure in general

Free format text: FINAL REJECTION MAILED

STPP Information on status: patent application and granting procedure in general

Free format text: AMENDMENT AFTER NOTICE OF APPEAL

STCV Information on status: appeal procedure

Free format text: NOTICE OF APPEAL FILED

STCB Information on status: application discontinuation

Free format text: ABANDONED -- FAILURE TO RESPOND TO AN OFFICE ACTION